]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
Minor cleanup.
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ---
21 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
22 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
23 installed programs.
24
25 ---
26 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
27
28 ---
29 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
30 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
31 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
32
33 ---
34 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with Lisp code.
35
36 ---
37 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
38 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
39 place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
40 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
41 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
42 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
43 in each user's home directory.
44
45 ---
46 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
47 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
48 Emacs with Leim.
49
50 +++
51 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
52
53 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
54 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
55 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
56 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
57
58 ---
59 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
60 the distribution.
61
62 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
63 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
64 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
65 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
66
67 ---
68 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
69 following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
70 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
71 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
72 doesn't automatically select the right one.
73
74 ---
75 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
76
77 ---
78 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
79 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
80 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
81 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
82
83 ---
84 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
85
86 ---
87 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
88
89 ---
90 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
94 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
95
96 ---
97 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
98
99 ---
100 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
101 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
102 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
103
104 ---
105 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
106 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
107
108 ---
109 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
110 much pure storage it will approximately need.
111
112 ** The script etc/emacs-buffer.gdb can be used with gdb to retrieve the
113 contents of buffers from a core dump and save them to files easily, should
114 emacs crash.
115
116 \f
117 * Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
118
119 +++
120 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
121 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
122 the fancy startup screen.
123
124 +++
125 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
126 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
127 the blinking cursor.
128
129 +++
130 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
131 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
132
133 +++
134 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
135 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
136 can start with this line:
137
138 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
139
140 +++
141 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
142 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
143 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
144
145 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
146
147 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
148 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
149
150 +++
151 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
152 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
153
154 +++
155 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
156 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
157 an interactively callable function.
158
159 +++
160 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
161 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
162 affects the initial frame.
163
164 +++
165 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
166 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
167 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
168 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
169 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
170
171 +++
172 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
173 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
174 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
175 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
176 `inhibit-splash-screen').
177
178 +++
179 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
180 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
181 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
182
183 +++
184 ** Init file changes
185 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
186 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
187
188 +++
189 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
190 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
191 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
192 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
193 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
194 \f
195 * Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
196
197 +++
198 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
199 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
200 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
201 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
202
203 +++
204 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
205 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
206
207 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
208 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
209
210 +++
211 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
212 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
213 the operating system or your X server.
214
215 +++
216 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
217
218 +++
219 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
220 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
221 you about it.
222
223 +++
224 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
225 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
226
227 +++
228 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
229 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
230 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
231
232 +++
233 ** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
234 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
235
236 +++
237 ** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
238
239 See below under "incremental search changes".
240
241 ---
242 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
243
244 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
245 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
246 directory with Dired.
247
248 +++
249 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
250 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
251 it remains unchanged.
252
253 +++
254 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
255 M-o M-o requests refontification.
256
257 +++
258 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
259
260 See below for more details.
261
262 +++
263 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
264 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
265 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
266 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
267 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
268 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
269 \f
270 * Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
271
272 +++
273 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
274 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
275
276 +++
277 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
278 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
279 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
280 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
281
282 +++
283 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
284 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
285
286 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
287 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
288
289 +++
290 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
291 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
292 the operating system or your X server.
293
294 +++
295 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
296
297 +++
298 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
299 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
300 you about it.
301
302 +++
303 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
304 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
305
306 +++
307 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left and
308 (prev-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and C-x right
309 can be used as well.
310
311 +++
312 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
313
314 +++
315 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
316 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
317
318 ---
319 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
320 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
321
322 ---
323 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
324 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
325
326 +++
327 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
328 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
329 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
330 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
331
332 +++
333 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
334 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
335 in Indented-Text mode.
336
337 +++
338 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
339
340 Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
341 now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
342 in the value, use `$$'.
343
344 +++
345 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
346 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
347 `same-window'.
348
349 +++
350 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
351 from the locale.
352
353 ** The command `list-faces-display' now accepts a prefix arg.
354 When passed, the function prompts for a regular expression and lists
355 only faces matching this regexp.
356
357 ** Mark command changes:
358
359 +++
360 *** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
361 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
362 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
363
364 +++
365 *** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
366
367 If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
368 (mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
369 extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
370 M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
371 mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
372 region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
373 the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
374 in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
375 or set the new mark with C-SPC.
376
377 +++
378 *** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
379
380 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
381 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
382 paragraphs.
383
384 +++
385 *** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
386 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
387 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
388 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
389 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
390 command only.
391
392 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
393 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
394 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
395 mark or the region.
396
397 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
398 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
399 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
400 C-g.
401
402 +++
403 *** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
404 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
405 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
406
407 ** Help command changes:
408
409 +++
410 *** Changes in C-h bindings:
411
412 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
413
414 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
415 that do not change:
416
417 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
418 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
419
420 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
421 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
422
423 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
424
425 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
426 run by the key sequence.
427
428 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
429 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
430 that command.
431
432 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
433 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
434
435 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
436 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
437
438 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
439 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
440
441 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
442 new-kill-line is on C-k
443
444 ---
445 *** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
446 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
447 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
448 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
449
450 +++
451 *** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
452 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
453
454 +++
455 *** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
456 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
457 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
458 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
459 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
460 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
461 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
462
463 +++
464 *** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
465 description various information about a character, including its
466 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
467 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
468 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
469
470 +++
471 *** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
472 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
473
474 +++
475 *** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
476 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
477 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
478 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
479 keyboard oriented alternative.
480
481 +++
482 *** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
483 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
484 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
485 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
486 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
487
488 +++
489 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
490 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
491 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
492 available.
493
494 +++
495 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
496 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
497 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
498 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
499 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
500 matching item.
501
502 ** Incremental Search changes:
503
504 +++
505 *** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
506 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
507 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
508 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
509 for details.
510
511 +++
512 *** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
513 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
514 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
515 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
516
517 +++
518 *** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
519 at the end of a line.
520
521 +++
522 *** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
523 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
524 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
525
526 +++
527 *** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
528 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
529 search string used as the string to replace.
530
531 +++
532 *** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
533 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
534 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
535
536 ** Replace command changes:
537
538 ---
539 *** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
540 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
541 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
542
543 +++
544 *** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
545 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
546 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
547 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
548 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
549 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
550 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
551 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
552 can be edited for each replacement.
553
554 +++
555 *** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
556 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
557
558 ---
559 *** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
560 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
561
562 ** File operation changes:
563
564 +++
565 *** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
566 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
567 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
568 is only rarely needed.
569
570 +++
571 *** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
572 suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
573
574 +++
575 *** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
576 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
577
578 +++
579 *** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
580 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
581
582 +++
583 *** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
584
585 ---
586 *** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
587
588 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
589 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
590 directory with Dired.
591
592 +++
593 *** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
594 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
595 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
596 file.)
597
598 +++
599 *** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
600 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
601
602 +++
603 *** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
604 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
605 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
606 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
607 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
608 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
609
610 ---
611 *** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
612 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
613 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
614
615 ---
616 *** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
617 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
618 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
619
620 +++
621 *** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
622 Emacs asks for confirmation.
623
624 +++
625 *** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
626
627 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
628 when visiting the file.
629
630 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
631 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
632 when saving the file.
633
634 +++
635 *** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
636 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
637 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
638 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
639 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
640 modes do.
641
642 ** Minibuffer changes:
643
644 +++
645 *** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
646 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
647 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
648 prompt string.
649
650 ---
651 *** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
652
653 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
654 have in common and where they begin to differ.
655
656 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
657 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
658 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
659 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
660 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
661 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
662 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
663 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
664
665 +++
666 *** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
667 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
668 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
669 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
670 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
671 candidate is a directory.
672
673 +++
674 *** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
675 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
676 it remains unchanged.
677
678 +++
679 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
680 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
681 elements are deleted.
682
683 ** Redisplay changes:
684
685 +++
686 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
687 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
688 appears between the position information and the major mode.
689
690 +++
691 *** New face `escape-glyph' highlights control characters and escape glyphs.
692
693 +++
694 *** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now displayed with a special
695 face, either nobreak-space or escape-glyph. You can turn this off or
696 specify a different mode by setting the variable `nobreak-char-display'.
697
698 +++
699 *** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
700 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
701 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
702 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
703
704 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
705 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
706 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
707 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
708 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
709 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
710
711 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
712 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
713
714 ---
715 *** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller that
716 the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
717 vscroll property.
718
719 +++
720 *** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
721 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
722 the mode line of the currently selected window.
723
724 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
725 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
726
727 +++
728 *** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
729 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
730 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
731 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
732 set-fringe-style.
733
734 +++
735 *** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
736 addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
737 the window can be scrolled.
738
739 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
740 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
741 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
742
743 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
744 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
745
746 The value can also be an alist which specifies the presence and
747 position of each bitmap individually.
748
749 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
750 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
751 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
752 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
753
754 +++
755 *** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
756 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
757 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
758 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
759 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
760
761 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
762 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
763
764 +++
765 *** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
766 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
767 outside those margins.
768
769 +++
770 *** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
771 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
772
773 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
774 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
775 or when the frame is resized.
776
777 ** Cursor display changes:
778
779 +++
780 *** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
781 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
782
783 +++
784 *** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
785
786 +++
787 *** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
788 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
789 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
790 cursor does.
791
792 +++
793 *** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
794 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
795 appears in.
796
797 +++
798 *** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
799 of the recognized cursor types.
800
801 ** New faces:
802
803 +++
804 *** `mode-line-highlight' is the standard face indicating mouse sensitive
805 elements on mode-line (and header-line) like `highlight' face on text
806 areas.
807
808 +++
809 *** `shadow' face defines the appearance of the "shadowed" text, i.e.
810 the text which should be less noticeable than the surrounding text.
811 This can be achieved by using shades of grey in contrast with either
812 black or white default foreground color. This generic shadow face
813 allows customization of the appearance of shadowed text in one place,
814 so package-specific faces can inherit from it.
815
816 ** Font-Lock changes:
817
818 +++
819 *** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
820 M-o M-o requests refontification.
821
822 +++
823 *** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
824 fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
825 modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
826
827 The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
828 fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
829 `Info-mode-hook'.
830
831 +++
832 *** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
833 current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
834 The default value is 1.
835
836 +++
837 *** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
838 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
839 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
840 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
841 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
842
843 +++
844 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
845
846 +++
847 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-comment-delimiter-face'.
848
849 +++
850 *** Easy to overlook single character negation can now be font-locked.
851 You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
852 the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
853 cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
854
855 ---
856 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
857 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
858 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
859 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
860 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
861
862 ---
863 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
864
865 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
866 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
867 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
868 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
869
870 ---
871 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
872
873 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
874 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
875 refontification takes place.
876
877 ** Menu support:
878
879 ---
880 *** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
881 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
882 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
883 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
884 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
885 current date and time, current line and column number in the
886 mode-line.
887
888 ---
889 *** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
890
891 ---
892 *** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
893
894 ---
895 *** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
896 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
897 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
898
899 +++
900 *** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
901 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
902
903 ---
904 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
905 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
906
907 +++
908 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
909 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
910 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
911
912 ---
913 *** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
914 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
915
916 +++
917 *** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
918 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
919 the new dialog.
920
921 ** Mouse changes:
922
923 +++
924 *** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
925 to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
926 mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
927 different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
928 be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
929 feature is not enabled.
930
931 +++
932 *** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
933 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
934 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
935 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
936 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
937 to give it focus.
938
939 +++
940 *** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
941
942 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
943 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
944 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
945 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
946 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
947 behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
948
949 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
950 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
951 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
952 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
953 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
954 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
955 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
956 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
957 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
958
959 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
960 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
961 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
962 you release it).
963
964 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
965 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
966
967 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
968 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
969
970 +++
971 *** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
972 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
973 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
974 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
975 also disable mouse highlighting.
976
977 +++
978 *** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
979 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
980 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
981
982 ---
983 *** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
984 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
985
986 ---
987 *** Emacs ignores mouse-2 clicks while the mouse wheel is being moved.
988
989 People tend to push the mouse wheel (which counts as a mouse-2 click)
990 unintentionally while turning the wheel, so these clicks are now
991 ignored. You can customize this with the mouse-wheel-click-event and
992 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
993
994 +++
995 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
996
997 ** Mule changes:
998
999 ---
1000 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
1001 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
1002 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
1003 This change can result in using the different coding systems as
1004 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
1005
1006 +++
1007 *** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1008 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1009 can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1010 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1011 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1012 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1013 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1014 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1015
1016 +++
1017 *** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
1018 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
1019
1020 +++
1021 *** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
1022 coding system.
1023
1024 +++
1025 *** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
1026 of a file.
1027
1028 ---
1029 *** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1030 unicode.
1031
1032 +++
1033 *** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1034 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1035 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1036 command.
1037
1038 +++
1039 *** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
1040 in the current input method to input a character at point.
1041
1042 +++
1043 *** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1044 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1045 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1046 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1047 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1048 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1049 mule-unicode-... ones.
1050
1051 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1052 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1053 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1054 possible.
1055
1056 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1057 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1058 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1059 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1060 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1061
1062 ---
1063 *** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1064 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1065 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1066 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1067
1068 ---
1069 *** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1070 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1071 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1072 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1073 automatically according to the locale.)
1074
1075 ---
1076 *** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1077 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1078 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1079 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1080 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1081 tamil-inscript.
1082
1083 ---
1084 *** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
1085 characters.
1086
1087 ---
1088 *** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
1089 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1090 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1091 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1092 M-f (forward-word)
1093 M-b (backward-word)
1094 M-d (kill-word)
1095 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1096 M-t (transpose-words)
1097 M-q (fill-paragraph)
1098
1099 ---
1100 *** Indian support has been updated.
1101 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1102 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1103 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1104 supported.
1105
1106 ---
1107 *** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1108
1109 ---
1110 *** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1111 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1112 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1113 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1114 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1115 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1116 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1117 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1118 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1119 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1120 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1121 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1122
1123 ---
1124 *** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1125 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1126 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1127
1128 ---
1129 *** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
1130 library. These include complete versions of most of those in
1131 codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
1132 obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
1133 and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
1134 latter is used by GNU locales.
1135
1136 ---
1137 *** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1138 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1139
1140 ---
1141 *** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1142 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1143 fontset appropriately.
1144
1145 ** Customize changes:
1146
1147 +++
1148 *** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1149 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1150 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1151 faces.
1152
1153 ---
1154 *** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1155 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1156 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1157 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1158 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1159 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1160 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1161
1162 +++
1163 *** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1164 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1165 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1166 under the "[State]" button.
1167
1168 ** Buffer Menu changes:
1169
1170 +++
1171 *** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1172 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
1173 mode.
1174
1175 +++
1176 *** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1177 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1178 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1179
1180 ---
1181 *** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1182 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1183 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1184
1185 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1186 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1187 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1188 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1189 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1190
1191 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1192 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1193 t, and the status is shown.
1194
1195 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1196 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1197
1198 ** Dired mode:
1199
1200 ---
1201 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1202 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1203 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
1204
1205 +++
1206 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1207 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1208
1209 +++
1210 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1211 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1212
1213 +++
1214 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1215 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1216 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1217 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1218 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1219 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1220
1221 +++
1222 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1223 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1224
1225 +++
1226 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1227
1228 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1229 dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1230 dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1231 instead.
1232
1233 +++
1234 *** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1235 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1236 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1237 directory listing into a buffer.
1238
1239 ** Comint changes:
1240
1241 ---
1242 *** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1243 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1244 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1245 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1246 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1247
1248 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1249 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1250
1251 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1252 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1253 lines, including any prompts.
1254
1255 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1256 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1257 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1258 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1259 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1260 `kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
1261 kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1262
1263 +++
1264 *** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1265 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1266 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1267 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1268
1269 +++
1270 *** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1271 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1272 but declared obsolete.
1273
1274 ** M-x Compile changes:
1275
1276 ---
1277 *** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1278
1279 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1280 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1281 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1282 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1283
1284 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1285 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1286 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1287
1288 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1289 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1290 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1291 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1292 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1293
1294 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1295
1296 +++
1297 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1298 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1299 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1300 subprocesses inherit.
1301
1302 +++
1303 *** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1304 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1305 in new face `next-error'.
1306
1307 +++
1308 *** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1309 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1310 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1311 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1312 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1313 C-c C-f.
1314
1315 +++
1316 *** When the left fringe is displayed, an arrow points to current message in
1317 the compilation buffer.
1318
1319 +++
1320 *** The new variable `compilation-context-lines' controls lines of leading
1321 context before the current message. If nil and the left fringe is displayed,
1322 it doesn't scroll the compilation output window. If there is no left fringe,
1323 no arrow is displayed and a value of nil means display the message at the top
1324 of the window.
1325
1326 ** Occur mode changes:
1327
1328 +++
1329 *** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1330 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1331 switching to it.
1332
1333 +++
1334 *** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1335 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1336
1337 +++
1338 *** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1339 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1340 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1341 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1342 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1343
1344 ** Grep changes:
1345
1346 +++
1347 *** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1348
1349 There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1350 customization group.
1351
1352 ---
1353 *** M-x grep provides highlighting support.
1354
1355 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1356 can be saved and automatically revisited.
1357
1358 +++
1359 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1360 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1361
1362 ---
1363 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1364 `grep-scroll-output' override the corresponding compilation mode
1365 settings, for grep commands only.
1366
1367 +++
1368 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
1369 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1370 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1371 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1372 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1373 source line is highlighted.
1374
1375 +++
1376 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1377 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1378 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1379 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1380 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1381 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1382 file.
1383
1384 +++
1385 *** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1386 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1387 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1388 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1389 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1390 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1391
1392 ** X Windows Support:
1393
1394 +++
1395 *** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1396 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1397 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1398
1399 +++
1400 *** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1401 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1402 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1403 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1404 Meta and Alt:
1405 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1406 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1407
1408 +++
1409 *** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
1410 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
1411
1412 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1413 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
1414
1415 ---
1416 *** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1417 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1418 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1419 and use the more appropriately result.
1420
1421 ---
1422 *** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1423 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1424 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1425
1426 ** Xterm support:
1427
1428 ---
1429 *** Emacs now responds to mouse-clicks on the mode-line, header-line and
1430 display margin, when run in an xterm.
1431
1432 ---
1433 *** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1434 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
1435 following should work:
1436 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1437 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1438 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1439
1440 ** Character terminal color support changes:
1441
1442 +++
1443 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1444 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1445 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1446 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1447 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1448 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1449 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1450 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1451 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1452
1453 ---
1454 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1455 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1456 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1457 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1458 all of these colors.
1459
1460 +++
1461 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1462 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1463 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1464 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1465 colors as on X.
1466
1467 ---
1468 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1469 \f
1470 * New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
1471
1472 +++
1473 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1474 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1475 program files that include other program files.
1476
1477 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1478 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1479 in them.
1480
1481 +++
1482 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1483
1484 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1485 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1486 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1487 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
1488
1489 ---
1490 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1491 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1492
1493 ---
1494 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1495
1496 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1497 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1498 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1499 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1500
1501 +++
1502 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1503 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1504
1505 ---
1506 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1507
1508 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1509 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1510 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1511 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1512 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1513 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1514
1515 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1516 rectangle highlighting: Use C-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1517 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1518 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1519
1520 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1521 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1522 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1523 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1524 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1525 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1526 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1527
1528 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1529 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1530 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1531
1532 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1533 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1534
1535 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1536 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1537 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1538 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1539
1540 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1541 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1542 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
1543 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1544
1545 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1546 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1547 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1548 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1549
1550 +++
1551 ** Org mode is now part of the Emacs distribution
1552
1553 Org mode is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining ToDo lists, and
1554 doing project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
1555 It also contains a plain-text table editor with spreadsheet-like
1556 capabilities.
1557
1558 The Org mode table editor can be integrated into any major mode by
1559 activating the minor Orgtbl-mode.
1560
1561 The documentation for org-mode is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1562 type "C-h i m org RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1563 available in `etc/orgcard.tex' and `etc/orgcard.ps'.
1564
1565 +++
1566 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1567 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1568 to increment the SOA serial.
1569
1570 ---
1571 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1572 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1573 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1574 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1575 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method can
1576 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1577
1578 +++
1579 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1580 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1581
1582 +++
1583 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1584 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1585 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1586 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1587 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1588
1589 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1590 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1591 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1592 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1593 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1594 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1595
1596 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1597 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1598 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1599 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1600 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1601 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1602 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1603 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1604 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1605 or local keymaps.
1606
1607 +++
1608 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1609 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1610
1611 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1612 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1613 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1614 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1615
1616 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1617 defined macros.
1618
1619 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1620 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1621 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1622 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1623 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1624 for more commands.
1625
1626 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1627 the keyboard macro ring.
1628
1629 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1630 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1631
1632 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1633 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1634 this behavior via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1635 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1636
1637 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1638 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1639 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1640
1641 ---
1642 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1643 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1644 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1645
1646 +++
1647 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1648 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
1649
1650 +++
1651 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1652 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1653 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1654 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1655 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1656 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1657 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1658 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1659 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1660
1661 +++
1662 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1663
1664 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1665 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1666 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1667 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1668 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1669 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1670
1671 ---
1672 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1673 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1674 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1675 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1676
1677 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1678
1679 ---
1680 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1681 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1682 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1683 settings.
1684
1685 +++
1686 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1687 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1688 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1689 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1690
1691 +++
1692 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1693 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1694
1695 +++
1696 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1697 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1698 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1699 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1700 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1701 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1702
1703 +++
1704 ** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
1705 and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
1706
1707 +++
1708 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1709
1710 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1711 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1712 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1713 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1714 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1715 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1716 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1717 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1718 `rsync' to do the copying).
1719
1720 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1721 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1722
1723 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1724
1725 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1726
1727 ---
1728 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1729
1730 ---
1731 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1732 configuration files.
1733
1734 +++
1735 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1736 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1737 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1738 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1739 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1740 recognized.
1741
1742 ---
1743 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1744
1745 +++
1746 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1747
1748 ---
1749 ** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1750 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
1751 \f
1752 * Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
1753
1754 ---
1755 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp and BSD make.
1756
1757 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter two
1758 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable
1759 faces.
1760
1761 +++
1762 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top
1763 of the file that precede the first header line.
1764
1765 +++
1766 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1767
1768 ---
1769 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved; it can
1770 run most curses applications now.
1771
1772 +++
1773 ** M-x diff uses Diff mode instead of Compilation mode.
1774
1775 +++
1776 ** You can now customize `fill-nobreak-predicate' to control where
1777 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
1778 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
1779
1780 Emacs provide two predicates, `fill-single-word-nobreak-p' and
1781 `fill-french-nobreak-p', for use as the value of
1782 `fill-nobreak-predicate'.
1783
1784 ---
1785 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
1786 with special modes such as Tar mode.
1787
1788 ---
1789 ** Commands `winner-redo' and `winner-undo', from winner.el, are now
1790 bound to C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an
1791 incompatible change.
1792
1793 ---
1794 ** `global-whitespace-mode' is a new alias for `whitespace-global-mode'.
1795
1796 +++
1797 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
1798 resync points in both windows.
1799
1800 +++
1801 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1802
1803 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1804 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1805
1806 ---
1807 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1808 when Emacs visits them.
1809
1810 ** Info mode changes:
1811
1812 +++
1813 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
1814 with the number appended to the `*info*' buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
1815
1816 ---
1817 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
1818
1819 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
1820 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
1821 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
1822 aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
1823 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
1824 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
1825 Info node.
1826
1827 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
1828 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
1829 search without prompting for a new search string.
1830
1831 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
1832 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
1833 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
1834
1835 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
1836
1837 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
1838 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
1839
1840 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
1841 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
1842 possible matches.
1843
1844 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
1845 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
1846 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
1847
1848 ---
1849 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
1850 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
1851
1852 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
1853 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
1854
1855 +++
1856 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
1857
1858 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
1859 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
1860
1861 ---
1862 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
1863
1864 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
1865 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
1866 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
1867
1868 +++
1869 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
1870
1871 ---
1872 *** `Info-index' offers completion.
1873
1874 ** Lisp mode changes:
1875
1876 ---
1877 *** Lisp mode now uses `font-lock-doc-face' for doc strings.
1878
1879 +++
1880 *** C-u C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-prints the list after point.
1881
1882 *** New features in evaluation commands
1883
1884 +++
1885 **** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
1886 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
1887
1888 +++
1889 **** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
1890 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
1891 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
1892 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
1893 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
1894
1895 +++
1896 ** CC mode changes.
1897
1898 *** Font lock support.
1899 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1900 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1901 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1902 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1903 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1904 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1905
1906 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1907 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1908 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1909 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1910 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1911 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1912 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1913 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1914 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1915
1916 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1917 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1918 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1919 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1920 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1921 take the better part of a minute.
1922
1923 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1924 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1925 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1926 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1927 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1928 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1929
1930 **** Support for documentation comments.
1931 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1932 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1933 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1934 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1935
1936 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1937 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1938 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1939 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1940
1941 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
1942 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
1943 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
1944 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
1945 parens.
1946
1947 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
1948 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
1949 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
1950 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
1951 not as configurable as it ought to be.
1952
1953 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
1954 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
1955 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
1956 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
1957 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
1958
1959 *** Support for the AWK language.
1960 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
1961 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
1962 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
1963 Here is a summary:
1964
1965 **** Indentation Engine
1966 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
1967
1968 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
1969 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
1970 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
1971 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
1972 definition, or structured statement.
1973
1974 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
1975 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
1976 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
1977
1978 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
1979 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
1980 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
1981 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
1982
1983 **** Font Locking
1984 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
1985 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
1986 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
1987 the AWK language itself.
1988
1989 **** Comment Commands
1990 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
1991 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
1992
1993 **** Movement Commands
1994 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
1995 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
1996 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
1997
1998 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
1999 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
2000 recognize these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
2001 functions.
2002
2003 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
2004 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
2005 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
2006 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
2007
2008 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
2009 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
2010 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
2011 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
2012 composition-close, and incomposition.
2013
2014 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
2015 The functions `c-hungry-backspace' and `c-hungry-delete-forward' can be
2016 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
2017
2018 *** Better control over `require-final-newline'.
2019
2020 The variable `c-require-final-newline' specifies which of the modes
2021 implemented by CC mode should insert final newlines. Its value is a
2022 list of modes, and only those modes should do it. By default the list
2023 includes C, C++ and Objective-C modes.
2024
2025 Whichever modes are in this list will set `require-final-newline'
2026 based on `mode-require-final-newline'.
2027
2028 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
2029
2030 The elements in the syntactic context returned by `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2031 and stored in `c-syntactic-context' has been changed somewhat to allow
2032 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2033 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
2034
2035 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
2036
2037 is now analyzed as
2038
2039 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
2040
2041 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2042 symbol.
2043
2044 This change might affect code that call `c-guess-basic-syntax' directly,
2045 and custom lineup functions if they use `c-syntactic-context'. However,
2046 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
2047 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
2048
2049 *** API changes for derived modes.
2050
2051 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2052 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2053 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2054 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2055 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2056
2057 **** New language variable system.
2058 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2059
2060 **** New initialization functions.
2061 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2062 give better control: `c-basic-common-init', `c-font-lock-init', and
2063 `c-init-language-vars'.
2064
2065 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2066 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2067 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2068 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2069
2070 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2071 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2072 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2073 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2074 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2075
2076 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2077 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2078 its substatement. E.g:
2079
2080 if (x)
2081 x_is_true:
2082 do_stuff();
2083
2084 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2085
2086 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2087 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2088 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2089 variable `c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros'. A new syntactic symbol
2090 `cpp-define-intro' has been added to control the initial indentation
2091 inside `#define's.
2092
2093 **** New lineup function `c-lineup-cpp-define'.
2094
2095 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2096 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2097 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2098 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2099 much line `c-lineup-dont-change', which was used earlier, but handles
2100 empty lines within the macro better.
2101
2102 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2103 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2104 `c-context-line-break' and `c-context-open-line'.
2105
2106 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2107 `c-backslash-region' tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2108 variable `c-backslash-max-column' which put a limit on how far out
2109 backslashes can be moved.
2110
2111 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2112 This is controlled by the new variable `c-auto-align-backslashes'. It
2113 affects `c-context-line-break', `c-context-open-line' and newlines
2114 inserted in Auto-Newline mode.
2115 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2116
2117 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2118 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2119 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2120 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2121 backslash) in the macro.
2122
2123 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2124 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2125 the variable `c-indent-comment-alist'. The indentation behavior based
2126 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
2127 and #endif but indentation to `comment-column' in most other cases
2128 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2129
2130 *** New function `c-context-open-line'.
2131 It's the open-line equivalent of `c-context-line-break'.
2132
2133 *** New lineup functions
2134
2135 **** `c-lineup-string-cont'
2136 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2137 continues. E.g:
2138
2139 result = prefix + "A message "
2140 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2141
2142 **** `c-lineup-cascaded-calls'
2143 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2144
2145 **** `c-lineup-knr-region-comment'
2146 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2147 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2148
2149 **** `c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg'
2150 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks.
2151
2152 **** `c-lineup-argcont'
2153 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2154
2155 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2156 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2157 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2158 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2159 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2160 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2161
2162 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2163 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2164 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2165 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2166 context.
2167
2168 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2169 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2170 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2171 happen when macros are involved.
2172
2173 *** Improved the way `c-indent-exp' chooses the block to indent.
2174 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2175 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2176 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2177 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2178 line is left untouched.
2179
2180 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2181 The function `c-toggle-syntactic-indentation' can be used to toggle
2182 syntactic indentation.
2183
2184 ---
2185 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2186
2187 ---
2188 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2189 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2190 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2191 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2192
2193 ** Fortran mode changes:
2194
2195 ---
2196 *** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2197 highlighting for the old default.
2198
2199 +++
2200 *** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2201 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2202 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2203
2204 +++
2205 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2206 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2207 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2208 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2209
2210 ---
2211 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for `hs-minor-mode' (hideshow).
2212 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2213 majority.
2214
2215 ---
2216 *** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2217 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2218
2219 ---
2220 ** Reftex mode changes
2221 +++
2222 *** Changes to RefTeX's table of contents
2223
2224 The new command keys "<" and ">" in the TOC buffer promote/demote the
2225 section at point or all sections in the current region, with full
2226 support for multifile documents.
2227
2228 The new command `reftex-toc-recenter' (`C-c -') shows the current
2229 section in the TOC buffer without selecting the TOC window.
2230 Recentering can happen automatically in idle time when the option
2231 `reftex-auto-recenter-toc' is turned on. The highlight in the TOC
2232 buffer stays when the focus moves to a different window. A dedicated
2233 frame can show the TOC with the current section always automatically
2234 highlighted. The frame is created and deleted from the toc buffer
2235 with the `d' key.
2236
2237 The toc window can be split off horizontally instead of vertically.
2238 See new option `reftex-toc-split-windows-horizontally'.
2239
2240 Labels can be renamed globally from the table of contents using the
2241 key `M-%'.
2242
2243 The new command `reftex-goto-label' jumps directly to a label
2244 location.
2245
2246 +++
2247 *** Changes related to citations and BibTeX database files
2248
2249 Commands that insert a citation now prompt for optional arguments when
2250 called with a prefix argument. Related new options are
2251 `reftex-cite-prompt-optional-args' and `reftex-cite-cleanup-optional-args'.
2252
2253 The new command `reftex-create-bibtex-file' creates a BibTeX database
2254 with all entries referenced in the current document. The keys "e" and
2255 "E" allow to produce a BibTeX database file from entries marked in a
2256 citation selection buffer.
2257
2258 The command `reftex-citation' uses the word in the buffer before the
2259 cursor as a default search string.
2260
2261 The support for chapterbib has been improved. Different chapters can
2262 now use BibTeX or an explicit `thebibliography' environment.
2263
2264 The macros which specify the bibliography file (like \bibliography)
2265 can be configured with the new option `reftex-bibliography-commands'.
2266
2267 Support for jurabib has been added.
2268
2269 +++
2270 *** Global index matched may be verified with a user function
2271
2272 During global indexing, a user function can verify an index match.
2273 See new option `reftex-index-verify-function'.
2274
2275 +++
2276 *** Parsing documents with many labels can be sped up.
2277
2278 Operating in a document with thousands of labels can be sped up
2279 considerably by allowing RefTeX to derive the type of a label directly
2280 from the label prefix like `eq:' or `fig:'. The option
2281 `reftex-trust-label-prefix' needs to be configured in order to enable
2282 this feature. While the speed-up is significant, this may reduce the
2283 quality of the context offered by RefTeX to describe a label.
2284
2285 +++
2286 *** Miscellaneous changes
2287
2288 The macros which input a file in LaTeX (like \input, \include) can be
2289 configured in the new option `reftex-include-file-commands'.
2290
2291 RefTeX supports global incremental search.
2292
2293 +++
2294 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2295 to support use of font-lock.
2296
2297 ** HTML/SGML changes:
2298
2299 ---
2300 *** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2301 automatically.
2302
2303 +++
2304 *** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2305 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2306 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2307 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2308 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2309 from the file name or buffer contents.
2310
2311 +++
2312 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2313
2314 ** TeX modes:
2315
2316 +++
2317 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2318
2319 +++
2320 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2321 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2322 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2323 TeX commands to use at startup.
2324
2325 ---
2326 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2327 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2328
2329 +++
2330 *** New major mode Doctex mode, for *.dtx files.
2331
2332 ** BibTeX mode:
2333
2334 *** The new command `bibtex-url' browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2335 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2336
2337 *** The new command `bibtex-entry-update' (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2338 an existing BibTeX entry.
2339
2340 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2341
2342 *** `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' can take values `plain',
2343 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2344 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2345 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2346 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2347 `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' is non-nil.
2348
2349 *** If the new variable `bibtex-parse-keys-fast' is non-nil,
2350 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
2351
2352 *** If the new variable `bibtex-autoadd-commas' is non-nil,
2353 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
2354
2355 *** The new variable `bibtex-autofill-types' contains a list of entry
2356 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2357
2358 *** The new command `bibtex-complete' completes word fragment before
2359 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2360
2361 *** The new commands `bibtex-find-entry' and `bibtex-find-crossref'
2362 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2363 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
2364
2365 *** In BibTeX mode the command `fill-paragraph' (M-q) fills
2366 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
2367
2368 *** The new variables `bibtex-files' and `bibtex-file-path' define a set
2369 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
2370
2371 *** The new command `bibtex-validate-globally' checks for duplicate keys
2372 in multiple BibTeX files.
2373
2374 *** The new command `bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill' pushes summary
2375 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
2376
2377 +++
2378 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2379 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2380 and `C-c C-r'.
2381
2382 ** GUD changes:
2383
2384 +++
2385 *** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
2386 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2387
2388 ---
2389 *** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
2390 and other common debugger commands.
2391
2392 +++
2393 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2394 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2395 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2396 state of your program. It can separate the input/output of your program from
2397 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2398 Emacs 21/22 such as the the toolbar, and bitmaps in the fringe to indicate
2399 breakpoints.
2400
2401 Use M-x gdb to start GDB-UI.
2402
2403 *** The variable tooltip-gud-tips-p has been removed. GUD tooltips can now be
2404 toggled independently of normal tooltips with the minor mode
2405 `gud-tooltip-mode'.
2406
2407 +++
2408 *** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2409 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2410 not executing.
2411
2412 ---
2413 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
2414
2415 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
2416 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
2417 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
2418 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2419 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2420
2421 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2422 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
2423 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2424 (gud-finish).
2425
2426 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2427 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2428
2429 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2430 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2431 Set `gud-jdb-use-classpath' to nil.
2432
2433 Added Customization Variables
2434
2435 *** `gud-jdb-command-name'. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2436
2437 *** `gud-jdb-use-classpath'. Allows selection of java source file searching
2438 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan `gud-jdb-directories' for
2439 java sources (previous method).
2440
2441 *** `gud-jdb-directories'. List of directories to scan and search for java
2442 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2443 is nil).
2444
2445 Minor Improvements
2446
2447 *** The STARTTLS wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2448 instead of the OpenSSL based `starttls' tool. For backwards
2449 compatibility, it prefers `starttls', but you can toggle
2450 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2451 `starttls' tool).
2452
2453 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2454
2455 ** Auto-Revert changes:
2456
2457 +++
2458 *** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
2459
2460 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2461 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2462 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2463 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2464 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
2465 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
2466 be mode dependent.
2467
2468 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2469 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2470 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2471 toggles this mode.
2472
2473 +++
2474 *** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
2475 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2476 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2477 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2478 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2479 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2480 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2481 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2482 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
2483
2484 +++
2485 *** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
2486 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2487 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2488 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2489 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
2490
2491 ---
2492 ** recentf changes.
2493
2494 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
2495 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2496 automatic cleanup.
2497
2498 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2499 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2500 keep in the recent list.
2501
2502 With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
2503 specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
2504 example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
2505 recent list with different symbolic links.
2506
2507 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2508 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2509 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2510
2511 +++
2512 ** Desktop package
2513
2514 +++
2515 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, `desktop-save-mode'.
2516
2517 +++
2518 *** The variable `desktop-enable' is obsolete.
2519
2520 Customize `desktop-save-mode' to enable desktop saving.
2521
2522 ---
2523 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2524 buffer list.
2525
2526 +++
2527 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers
2528 immediately, remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is
2529 idle).
2530
2531 +++
2532 *** New commands:
2533 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2534 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2535 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2536 it was loaded.
2537 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2538 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
2539
2540 ---
2541 *** New customizable variables:
2542 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2543 killed.
2544 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2545 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2546 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2547 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2548 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2549 should not delete.
2550 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2551 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2552 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2553 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
2554
2555 +++
2556 *** New command line option --no-desktop
2557
2558 ---
2559 *** New hooks:
2560 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2561 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2562
2563 ---
2564 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2565
2566 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2567 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2568 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2569 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2570 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2571 feature.
2572
2573 ** EDiff changes.
2574
2575 +++
2576 *** When comparing directories.
2577 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2578 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2579 from one directory to another.
2580
2581 +++
2582 *** When comparing files or buffers.
2583 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2584 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2585 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2586 comparison.
2587
2588 +++
2589 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
2590 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2591 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2592
2593 +++
2594 ** Etags changes.
2595
2596 *** New regular expressions features
2597
2598 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
2599
2600 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2601 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2602 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2603 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2604 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
2605 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2606 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2607 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2608 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2609 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2610
2611 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in GCC.
2612
2613 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2614 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2615 CR, TAB, VT,
2616
2617 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
2618
2619 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2620 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2621 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2622
2623 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
2624
2625 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2626 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2627
2628 *** New language parsing features
2629
2630 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2631
2632 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2633
2634 **** The GCC __attribute__ keyword is now recognized and ignored.
2635
2636 **** New language HTML.
2637
2638 Tags are generated for `title' as well as `h1', `h2', and `h3'. Also,
2639 when `name=' is used inside an anchor and whenever `id=' is used.
2640
2641 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2642
2643 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2644 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2645
2646 **** New language Lua.
2647
2648 All functions are tagged.
2649
2650 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
2651
2652 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2653 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2654 package::sub.
2655
2656 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2657
2658 **** New language PHP.
2659
2660 Functions, classes and defines are tags. If the --members option is
2661 specified to etags, variables are tags also.
2662
2663 **** New default keywords for TeX.
2664
2665 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2666 renewenvironment.
2667
2668 *** Honour #line directives.
2669
2670 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2671 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2672 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2673 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2674 writes tags pointing to the source file.
2675
2676 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
2677
2678 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
2679 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
2680 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
2681 the file FILE.
2682
2683 ** VC Changes
2684
2685 +++
2686 *** The key C-x C-q only changes the read-only state of the buffer
2687 (toggle-read-only). It no longer checks files in or out.
2688
2689 We made this change because we held a poll and found that many users
2690 were unhappy with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this
2691 behavior, you can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your
2692 `.emacs' file:
2693
2694 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
2695
2696 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
2697
2698 +++
2699 *** The new variable `vc-cvs-global-switches' specifies switches that
2700 are passed to any CVS command invoked by VC.
2701
2702 These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which means they
2703 are inserted before the command name. For example, this allows you to
2704 specify a compression level using the `-z#' option for CVS.
2705
2706 +++
2707 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
2708
2709 +++
2710 *** VC-Annotate mode enhancements
2711
2712 In VC-Annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2713 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2714 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2715
2716 P: annotates the previous revision
2717 N: annotates the next revision
2718 J: annotates the revision at line
2719 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2720 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2721 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2722 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2723
2724 ** pcl-cvs changes:
2725
2726 +++
2727 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2728 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2729 in the repository.
2730
2731 +++
2732 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2733 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2734 `checkout', `update' or `commit'. That means using cvs diff options
2735 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2736
2737 +++
2738 ** The new variable `mail-default-directory' specifies
2739 `default-directory' for mail buffers. This directory is used for
2740 auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to "~/".
2741
2742 +++
2743 ** The mode line can indicate new mail in a directory or file.
2744
2745 See the documentation of the user option
2746 `display-time-mail-directory'.
2747
2748 ** Rmail changes:
2749
2750 ---
2751 *** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2752
2753 +++
2754 *** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2755
2756 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2757 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2758 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2759 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2760 used instead of the native one.
2761
2762 ** Gnus package
2763
2764 ---
2765 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
2766
2767 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
2768 PGP/MIME.
2769
2770 ---
2771 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
2772
2773 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
2774
2775 ---
2776 ** MH-E changes.
2777
2778 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.84. There have been major changes since
2779 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
2780
2781 ** Calendar changes:
2782
2783 +++
2784 *** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
2785 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
2786
2787 +++
2788 *** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
2789 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
2790 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
2791 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
2792 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
2793 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
2794 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
2795 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
2796 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
2797
2798 +++
2799 *** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
2800 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
2801 count backward from the end of the year.
2802
2803 +++
2804 *** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
2805 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
2806 day of that ISO week.
2807
2808 ---
2809 *** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
2810 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
2811
2812 ---
2813 *** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
2814 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
2815 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
2816 `christian-holidays' simpler.
2817
2818 ---
2819 *** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
2820 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
2821 and `diary-header-line-format'.
2822
2823 +++
2824 *** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed:
2825 use the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
2826 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
2827 `appt-issue-message', `appt-visible', and `appt-msg-window'.
2828
2829 +++
2830 *** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
2831 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
2832 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
2833 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
2834 formats.
2835
2836 ---
2837 ** sql changes.
2838
2839 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
2840 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
2841 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
2842 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
2843 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
2844
2845 The following values are supported:
2846
2847 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
2848 db2 DB2
2849 informix Informix
2850 ingres Ingres
2851 interbase Interbase
2852 linter Linter
2853 ms Microsoft
2854 mysql MySQL
2855 oracle Oracle
2856 postgres Postgres
2857 solid Solid
2858 sqlite SQLite
2859 sybase Sybase
2860
2861 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
2862 SQL mode indicator.
2863
2864 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
2865 your `.emacs' will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
2866 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
2867
2868 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
2869
2870 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
2871 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
2872 all identifiers ending in `_t' under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
2873 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
2874
2875 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
2876 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
2877
2878 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i.
2879
2880 Most SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
2881 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
2882
2883 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
2884
2885 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
2886 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
2887 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
2888 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
2889 terminated.
2890
2891 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
2892 called with the `-E' command line argument to use the operating system
2893 credentials to authenticate the user.
2894
2895 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
2896 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
2897 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
2898
2899 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
2900 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
2901
2902 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
2903 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
2904 defaults.
2905
2906 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
2907 appropriate `sql-interactive-mode' wrapper for the current setting of
2908 `sql-product'.
2909
2910 ---
2911 *** sql.el supports the SQLite interpreter--call 'sql-sqlite'.
2912
2913 ** FFAP changes:
2914
2915 +++
2916 *** New ffap commands and keybindings:
2917
2918 C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
2919 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
2920 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
2921 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
2922
2923 ---
2924 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default.
2925
2926 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS
2927 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
2928
2929 ---
2930 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction.
2931
2932 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer
2933 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark
2934 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The
2935 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along
2936 with other details of skeleton construction.
2937
2938 ---
2939 ** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
2940 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
2941 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
2942 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
2943
2944 +++
2945 ** `hide-ifdef-mode' now uses overlays rather than selective-display
2946 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
2947 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
2948
2949 ---
2950 ** `partial-completion-mode' now handles partial completion on directory names.
2951
2952 ---
2953 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
2954 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
2955 you don't want the `.type-break' file in your home directory or are
2956 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
2957
2958 ---
2959 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
2960
2961 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
2962 `ps-print', provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF
2963 fonts. See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
2964
2965 ---
2966 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
2967 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
2968 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
2969 using strokes as an input method.
2970
2971 ** Emacs server changes:
2972
2973 +++
2974 *** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
2975
2976 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
2977 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
2978 % emacsclient -s foo file1
2979 % emacsclient -s bar file2
2980
2981 +++
2982 *** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
2983 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given Lisp
2984 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
2985
2986 +++
2987 *** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
2988
2989 ---
2990 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
2991
2992 +++
2993 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
2994
2995 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
2996 argument it toggles the mode. Turning off PC-Selection mode restores
2997 the global key bindings that were replaced by turning on the mode.
2998
2999 ---
3000 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
3001 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
3002
3003 ---
3004 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
3005
3006 Emacs still works on terminals that require magic cookies in order to
3007 use standout mode, but they can no longer display mode-lines in
3008 inverse-video.
3009
3010 ---
3011 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
3012
3013 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
3014 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
3015 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
3016
3017 ---
3018 ** display-battery-mode replaces display-battery.
3019
3020 ---
3021 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode.
3022
3023 To enable this, set `calculator-output-radix' non-nil. In this mode a
3024 separator character is used every few digits, making it easier to see
3025 byte boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the
3026 variable `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
3027
3028 ---
3029 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
3030
3031 ---
3032 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
3033
3034 ---
3035 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted.
3036 \f
3037 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
3038
3039 +++
3040 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
3041
3042 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
3043 existing values. For example:
3044
3045 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
3046
3047 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
3048 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
3049
3050 ---
3051 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
3052
3053 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
3054 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
3055
3056 ---
3057 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
3058
3059 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
3060
3061 ---
3062 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
3063
3064 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
3065 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
3066 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
3067 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
3068 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
3069 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
3070
3071 ---
3072 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
3073
3074 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
3075 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
3076 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
3077 sound support for those formats.
3078
3079 ---
3080 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
3081
3082 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
3083
3084 ---
3085 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
3086
3087 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
3088 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
3089 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
3090
3091 ---
3092 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
3093
3094 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
3095 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
3096 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
3097 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
3098 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
3099 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
3100 you wish to use them in other faces.
3101
3102 ---
3103 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
3104
3105 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
3106 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
3107 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
3108 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
3109 any customizations.
3110
3111 ---
3112 ** On Mac OS, `keyboard-coding-system' changes based on the keyboard script.
3113
3114 ---
3115 ** The variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
3116 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
3117 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
3118 \f
3119 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3120
3121 ---
3122 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have
3123 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead.
3124
3125 +++
3126 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
3127 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
3128 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3129 `undefined'.)
3130
3131 +++
3132 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3133 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3134 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3135
3136 ---
3137 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3138 \f
3139 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3140
3141 ** General Lisp changes:
3142
3143 +++
3144 *** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3145
3146 +++
3147 *** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3148
3149 +++
3150 *** `add-to-list' takes an optional third argument, APPEND.
3151
3152 If APPEND is non-nil, the new element gets added at the end of the
3153 list instead of at the beginning. This change actually occurred in
3154 Emacs 21.1, but was not documented then.
3155
3156 +++
3157 *** New function `add-to-ordered-list' is like `add-to-list' but
3158 associates a numeric ordering of each element added to the list.
3159
3160 +++
3161 *** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree.
3162
3163 It recursively copyies through both CARs and CDRs.
3164
3165 +++
3166 *** New function `delete-dups' deletes `equal' duplicate elements from a list.
3167
3168 It modifies the list destructively, like `delete'. Of several `equal'
3169 occurrences of an element in the list, the one that's kept is the
3170 first one.
3171
3172 +++
3173 *** New function `rassq-delete-all'.
3174
3175 (rassq-delete-all VALUE ALIST) deletes, from ALIST, each element whose
3176 CDR is `eq' to the specified value.
3177
3178 +++
3179 *** The function `number-sequence' makes a list of equally-separated numbers.
3180
3181 For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9). By
3182 default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different
3183 separation as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns
3184 (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3185
3186 +++
3187 *** New variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'.
3188
3189 They hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3190
3191 +++
3192 *** Minor change in the function `format'.
3193
3194 Some flags that were accepted but not implemented (such as "*") are no
3195 longer accepted.
3196
3197 +++
3198 *** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer give errors for bad plists.
3199
3200 They return nil for a malformed property list or if the list is
3201 cyclic.
3202
3203 +++
3204 *** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3205
3206 They are like `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare
3207 the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3208
3209 +++
3210 *** New variable `print-continuous-numbering'.
3211
3212 When this is non-nil, successive calls to print functions use a single
3213 numbering scheme for circular structure references. This is only
3214 relevant when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3215
3216 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3217 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3218
3219 +++
3220 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3221
3222 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3223 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3224 if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
3225
3226 +++
3227 *** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3228
3229 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3230 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3231 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3232
3233 +++
3234 *** A function or macro's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
3235
3236 You put this info in the doc string's last line. It should be
3237 formatted so as to match the regexp "\n\n(fn .*)\\'". If you don't
3238 specify this explicitly, Emacs determines it from the actual argument
3239 names. Usually that default is right, but not always.
3240
3241 +++
3242 *** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily allows quitting.
3243
3244 A quit inside the body of `with-local-quit' is caught by the
3245 `with-local-quit' form itself, but another quit will happen later once
3246 the code that has inhibitted quitting exits.
3247
3248 This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code
3249 inside timer functions and `post-command-hook' functions.
3250
3251 +++
3252 *** New macro `define-obsolete-function-alias'.
3253
3254 This combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
3255
3256 +++
3257 *** New function `unsafep' determines whether a Lisp form is safe.
3258
3259 It returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly do anything
3260 dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be unsafe
3261 (calls unknown function, alters global variable, etc).
3262
3263 *** `list-faces-display' takes an optional argument, REGEXP.
3264
3265 If it is non-nil, the function lists only faces matching this regexp.
3266
3267 ** Lisp code indentation features:
3268
3269 +++
3270 *** The `defmacro' form can contain indentation and edebug declarations.
3271
3272 These declarations specify how to indent the macro calls in Lisp mode
3273 and how to debug them with Edebug. You write them like this:
3274
3275 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3276
3277 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3278 possible declaration specifiers are:
3279
3280 (indent INDENT)
3281 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3282
3283 (edebug DEBUG)
3284 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3285 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro,
3286 but this is cleaner.)
3287
3288 ---
3289 *** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
3290
3291 See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3292
3293 ---
3294 *** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3295
3296 The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3297 `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3298 be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3299 forms.
3300
3301 +++
3302 ** Variable aliases:
3303
3304 *** New function: defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3305
3306 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3307 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3308 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3309 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3310
3311 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3312 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3313
3314 *** New function: indirect-variable VARIABLE
3315
3316 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3317 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3318 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3319
3320 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3321 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3322
3323 +++
3324 *** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3325 `make-obsolete-variable'.
3326
3327 ** defcustom changes:
3328
3329 +++
3330 *** The new customization type `float' requires a floating point number.
3331
3332 ** String changes:
3333
3334 +++
3335 *** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character.
3336
3337 Exception: In a character constant, if it is followed by a `-' in a
3338 character constant (e.g. ?\s-A), it is still interpreted as the super
3339 modifier. In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3340
3341 +++
3342 *** A hex escape in a string constant forces the string to be multibyte.
3343
3344 +++
3345 *** An octal escape in a string constant forces the string to be unibyte.
3346
3347 +++
3348 *** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3349 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3350 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3351 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3352 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3353
3354 +++
3355 *** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3356 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3357
3358 +++
3359 *** New function `substring-no-properties' returns a substring without
3360 text properties.
3361
3362 +++
3363 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3364 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3365 been declared obsolete.
3366
3367 +++
3368 ** Displaying warnings to the user.
3369
3370 See the functions `warn' and `display-warning', or the Lisp Manual.
3371 If you want to be sure the warning will not be overlooked, this
3372 facility is much better than using `message', since it displays
3373 warnings in a separate window.
3374
3375 +++
3376 ** Progress reporters.
3377
3378 These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3379 progress messages for the user.
3380
3381 See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3382 `progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3383 `progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
3384
3385 ** Buffer positions:
3386
3387 +++
3388 *** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3389 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3390 the usable window height and width is used.
3391
3392 +++
3393 *** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3394 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3395 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presence of
3396 large images. To disable this feature, bind the new variable
3397 `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3398
3399 +++
3400 *** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word' is optional.
3401
3402 It defaults to 1.
3403
3404 +++
3405 *** Argument to `forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is optional.
3406
3407 It defaults to 1.
3408
3409 +++
3410 *** New function `mouse-on-link-p' test if a position is in a clickable link.
3411
3412 This is the function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link'
3413 functionality.
3414
3415 +++
3416 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of a position.
3417
3418 It an optional buffer position argument that defaults to point.
3419
3420 +++
3421 *** `field-beginning' and `field-end' take new optional argument, LIMIT.
3422
3423 This argument tells them not to search beyond LIMIT. Instead they
3424 give up and return LIMIT.
3425
3426 +++
3427 *** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3428 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3429 arg is non-nil.
3430
3431 +++
3432 *** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3433 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3434 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
3435
3436 ** Text modification:
3437
3438 +++
3439 *** The new function `insert-for-yank' normally works like `insert', but
3440 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list
3441 and handles the `yank-handler' text property.
3442
3443 +++
3444 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' is like
3445 `insert-for-yank' except that it gets the text from another buffer as
3446 in `insert-buffer-substring'.
3447
3448 +++
3449 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3450 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes all text properties from the
3451 inserted substring.
3452
3453 +++
3454 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3455 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3456 the filtered substring. Use it instead of `buffer-substring' or
3457 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3458 data structure, such as the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register.
3459
3460 The list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3461 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode adds to
3462 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3463 text.
3464
3465 +++
3466 *** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3467 argument.
3468
3469 +++
3470 *** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3471 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3472 be inserted is translated through it.
3473
3474 ---
3475 *** Text clones.
3476
3477 The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3478 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3479 clone to the other.
3480
3481 ---
3482 *** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
3483
3484 ** Filling changes.
3485
3486 +++
3487 *** In determining an adaptive fill prefix, Emacs now tries the function in
3488 `adaptive-fill-function' _before_ matching the buffer line against
3489 `adaptive-fill-regexp' rather than _after_ it.
3490
3491 +++
3492 ** Atomic change groups.
3493
3494 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3495 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3496 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3497
3498 (atomic-change-group
3499 (insert foo)
3500 (delete-region x y))
3501
3502 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3503 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3504 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3505 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3506
3507 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3508 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3509
3510 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3511 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3512 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3513 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3514
3515 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3516 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3517 do this.
3518
3519 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3520 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3521 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3522 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3523
3524 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3525 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3526 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3527 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3528 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3529 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3530 twice.
3531
3532 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3533 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3534 returned values, like this:
3535
3536 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3537 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3538
3539 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3540 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3541 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3542
3543 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3544 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3545 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3546 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3547 finished.
3548
3549 ** Buffer-related changes:
3550
3551 ---
3552 *** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
3553
3554 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
3555
3556 +++
3557 *** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
3558
3559 +++
3560 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
3561 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
3562 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
3563 value of VARIABLE instead.
3564
3565 ** Local variables lists:
3566
3567 +++
3568 *** Text properties in local variables.
3569
3570 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3571 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3572
3573 +++
3574 *** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3575 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3576 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3577 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3578 needed.
3579
3580 ---
3581 *** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3582 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3583 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3584 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3585 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3586 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3587
3588 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3589 confirmation as before.
3590
3591 ** Searching and matching changes:
3592
3593 +++
3594 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
3595 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
3596 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
3597
3598 +++
3599 *** The new variable `search-spaces-regexp' controls how to search
3600 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
3601 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
3602 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
3603
3604 Spaces inside of constructs such as `[..]' and inside loops such as
3605 `*', `+', and `?' are never replaced with `search-spaces-regexp'.
3606
3607 +++
3608 *** New regular expression operators, `\_<' and `\_>'.
3609
3610 These match the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
3611 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
3612 specified by the syntax table.
3613
3614 ---
3615 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
3616
3617 +++
3618 *** `skip-chars-forward' and `skip-chars-backward' now handle
3619 character classes such as `[:alpha:]', along with individual
3620 characters and ranges.
3621
3622 ---
3623 *** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
3624 properties from surrounding text.
3625
3626 +++
3627 *** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3628 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3629 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
3630
3631 +++
3632 *** Functions `match-data' and `set-match-data' now have an optional
3633 argument `reseat'. When non-nil, all markers in the match data list
3634 passed to these function will be reseated to point to nowhere.
3635
3636 +++
3637 *** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
3638 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
3639 that end a sentence without following spaces.
3640
3641 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
3642 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
3643 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
3644 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
3645 `sentence-end-without-space'.
3646
3647 ** Undo changes:
3648
3649 +++
3650 *** `buffer-undo-list' can allows programmable elements.
3651
3652 These elements have the form (apply FUNNAME . ARGS), where FUNNAME is
3653 a symbol other than t or nil. That stands for a high-level change
3654 that should be undone by evaluating (apply FUNNAME ARGS).
3655
3656 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
3657 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
3658 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
3659
3660 +++
3661 *** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
3662 `undo-outer-limit', garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
3663 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
3664
3665 +++
3666 ** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
3667 previously killed text on the kill ring is reinserted.
3668
3669 The value of the `yank-handler' property must be a list with one to four
3670 elements with the following format:
3671 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3672
3673 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3674 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3675 element on the kill-ring). If a `yank-handler' property is found,
3676 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3677
3678 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3679 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3680 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3681 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3682 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3683 rectangle.
3684 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3685 `yank-excluded-properties' is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3686 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3687 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3688 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3689 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
3690 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
3691 FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
3692
3693 *** The functions `kill-new', `kill-append', and `kill-region' now have an
3694 optional argument to specify the `yank-handler' text property to put on
3695 the killed text.
3696
3697 *** The function `yank-pop' will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3698 `yank-undo-function' (instead of `delete-region') to undo the previous
3699 `yank' or `yank-pop' command (or a call to `insert-for-yank'). The function
3700 `insert-for-yank' automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3701 element of the string argument's `yank-handler' text property if present.
3702
3703 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
3704 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
3705 string. The old behavior is available if you call
3706 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
3707
3708 ** Syntax table changes:
3709
3710 +++
3711 *** The macro `with-syntax-table' no longer copies the syntax table.
3712
3713 +++
3714 *** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
3715 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
3716 of text properties as well as the character code.
3717
3718 +++
3719 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
3720 by `syntax-after').
3721
3722 +++
3723 *** The new function `syntax-ppss' rovides an efficient way to find the
3724 current syntactic context at point.
3725
3726 ** File operation changes:
3727
3728 +++
3729 *** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
3730 searching for an executable or an Emacs Lisp file.
3731
3732 +++
3733 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
3734 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
3735 operation.
3736
3737 +++
3738 *** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3739 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3740 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
3741 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
3742
3743 +++
3744 *** `buffer-auto-save-file-format' is the new name for what was
3745 formerly called `auto-save-file-format'. It is now a permanent local.
3746
3747 +++
3748 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
3749 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
3750 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
3751
3752 +++
3753 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
3754
3755 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
3756
3757 +++
3758 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
3759 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
3760
3761 +++
3762 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
3763 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
3764 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
3765 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
3766
3767 +++
3768 *** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
3769 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
3770 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
3771 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
3772
3773 +++
3774 *** If `buffer-save-without-query' is non-nil in some buffer,
3775 `save-some-buffers' will always save that buffer without asking (if
3776 it's modified).
3777
3778 +++
3779 *** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
3780 `locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
3781 lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
3782 try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
3783 of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
3784 of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
3785 further filter candidate files.
3786
3787 One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
3788 `exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
3789 executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependancies.
3790
3791 ---
3792 *** The precedence of file name handlers has been changed.
3793
3794 Instead of choosing the first handler that matches,
3795 `find-file-name-handler' now gives precedence to a file name handler
3796 that matches nearest the end of the file name. More precisely, the
3797 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen. In case
3798 of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3799
3800 +++
3801 *** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
3802
3803 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
3804 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
3805 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
3806 operations.
3807
3808 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
3809 autoloaded when not really necessary.
3810
3811 ** Input changes:
3812
3813 +++
3814 *** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
3815 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
3816 previous `k' or `K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
3817
3818 +++
3819 *** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
3820 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
3821 it returns just the directory name.
3822
3823 ---
3824 *** Functions `y-or-n-p', `read-char', `read-key-sequence' and the like, that
3825 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
3826 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
3827
3828 +++
3829 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
3830 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
3831 quit had occurred. `while-no-input' returns the value of BODY, if BODY
3832 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted.
3833
3834 ** Minibuffer changes:
3835
3836 +++
3837 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
3838 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
3839 defaults to the current buffer.
3840
3841 +++
3842 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which
3843 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
3844
3845 +++
3846 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
3847 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
3848
3849 +++
3850 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
3851 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
3852 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
3853 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
3854 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
3855
3856 ---
3857 *** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by Lisp code
3858 to override the built-in `read-file-name' function.
3859
3860 +++
3861 *** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
3862 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
3863 `read-file-name' function.
3864
3865 +++
3866 *** The new function `read-directory-name' for reading a directory name.
3867
3868 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better
3869 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories.
3870
3871 ** Completion changes:
3872
3873 +++
3874 *** The functions `all-completions' and `try-completion' now accept lists
3875 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
3876 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
3877 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
3878 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
3879
3880 +++
3881 *** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
3882 as a dynamic completion table.
3883
3884 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
3885
3886 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
3887 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
3888 completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
3889 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
3890 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
3891 entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
3892
3893 +++
3894 *** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
3895 as a lazy completion table.
3896
3897 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
3898
3899 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
3900 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
3901 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
3902 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
3903 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
3904 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
3905
3906 +++
3907 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
3908
3909 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
3910
3911 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
3912 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
3913 example,
3914
3915 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
3916
3917 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
3918
3919 This is an alternative to using `defadvice' or `substitute-key-definition'
3920 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
3921 binding and lookup functionality.
3922
3923 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
3924 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3925 original command.
3926
3927 Example:
3928 Suppose that minor mode `my-mode' has defined the commands
3929 `my-kill-line' and `my-kill-word', and it wants C-k (and any other key
3930 bound to `kill-line') to run the command `my-kill-line' instead of
3931 `kill-line', and likewise it wants to run `my-kill-word' instead of
3932 `kill-word'.
3933
3934 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3935 command remapping allows you to directly map `kill-line' into
3936 `my-kill-line' and `kill-word' into `my-kill-word' using `define-key':
3937
3938 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3939 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
3940
3941 When `my-mode' is enabled, its minor mode keymap is enabled too. So
3942 when the user types C-k, that runs the command `my-kill-line'.
3943
3944 Only one level of remapping is supported. In the above example, this
3945 means that if `my-kill-line' is remapped to `other-kill', then C-k still
3946 runs `my-kill-line'.
3947
3948 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3949
3950 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3951 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3952 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3953 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
3954
3955 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3956 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
3957
3958 - `key-binding' now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
3959 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
3960
3961 - `where-is-internal' now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3962 `kill-line', when `my-mode' is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3963 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3964 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3965 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns "C-k" for `kill-line', and
3966 "<kill-line>" for `my-kill-line').
3967
3968 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3969 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3970 command was not remapped.
3971
3972 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
3973 over minor mode keymaps.
3974
3975 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
3976 text properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
3977 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
3978
3979 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
3980
3981 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
3982 bindings of the parent keymap.
3983
3984 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
3985
3986 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
3987 active keymaps.
3988
3989 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
3990 defined keys and their definitions.
3991
3992 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt string of a keymap.
3993
3994 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
3995 in the keymap.
3996
3997 *** New variable `emulation-mode-map-alists'.
3998
3999 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
4000 keymap alist separate from `minor-mode-map-alist' by adding their
4001 keymap alist to this list.
4002
4003 ** Abbrev changes:
4004
4005 +++
4006 *** The new function `copy-abbrev-table' copies an abbrev table.
4007
4008 It returns a new abbrev table that is a copy of a given abbrev table.
4009
4010 +++
4011 *** `define-abbrev' now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG.
4012
4013 If non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means
4014 that it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the
4015 abbrevs. Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always
4016 specify this flag.
4017
4018 +++
4019 ** Enhancements to process support
4020
4021 *** Function `list-processes' now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
4022 it lists only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set.
4023
4024 *** New fns `set-process-query-on-exit-flag' and `process-query-on-exit-flag'.
4025
4026 These replace the old function `process-kill-without-query'. That
4027 function is still supported, but new code should use the new
4028 functions.
4029
4030 *** Function `signal-process' now accepts a process object or process
4031 name in addition to a process id to identify the signaled process.
4032
4033 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
4034 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
4035
4036 Use the new functions `process-get' and `process-put' to access, add,
4037 and modify elements on this property list. Use the new functions
4038 `process-plist' and `set-process-plist' to access and replace the
4039 entire property list of a process.
4040
4041 *** Function `accept-process-output' has a new optional fourth arg
4042 JUST-THIS-ONE. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
4043 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
4044 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
4045 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
4046 speech synthesis.
4047
4048 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
4049
4050 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
4051 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
4052 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
4053 by setting the new variable `process-adaptive-read-buffering' to a
4054 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
4055 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
4056 emacs tries to read it.
4057
4058 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
4059
4060 This executes a shell command command synchronously in a separate
4061 process.
4062
4063 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
4064 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
4065 `default-directory'.
4066
4067 *** A process filter function gets the output as multibyte string
4068 if the process specifies t for its filter's multibyteness.
4069
4070 That multibyteness is decided by the value of
4071 `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is created, and
4072 you can change it later with `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
4073
4074 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
4075 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4076
4077 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
4078 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4079
4080 *** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
4081 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
4082 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
4083 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
4084 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
4085
4086 +++
4087 ** Enhanced networking support.
4088
4089 *** The new `make-network-process' function makes network connections.
4090 It allows opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
4091 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
4092
4093 - A server is started using :server t arg.
4094 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
4095 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
4096 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
4097 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
4098 - The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
4099 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
4100 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
4101
4102 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
4103 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
4104
4105 *** The old `open-network-stream' now uses `make-network-process'.
4106
4107 *** New functions `process-datagram-address', `set-process-datagram-address'.
4108
4109 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
4110 and set the current address of the remote partner.
4111
4112 *** New function `format-network-address'.
4113
4114 This function reformats the Lisp representation of a network address
4115 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
4116 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
4117 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
4118 string for other formatting options.
4119
4120 *** `process-contact' has an optional KEY argument.
4121
4122 Depending on this argument, you can get the complete list of network
4123 process properties or a specific property. Using :local or :remote as
4124 the KEY, you get the address of the local or remote end-point.
4125
4126 An Inet address is represented as a 5 element vector, where the first
4127 4 elements contain the IP address and the fifth is the port number.
4128
4129 *** New functions `stop-process' and `continue-process'.
4130
4131 These functions stop and restart communication through a network
4132 connection. For a server process, no connections are accepted in the
4133 stopped state. For a client process, no input is received in the
4134 stopped state.
4135
4136 *** New function `network-interface-list'.
4137
4138 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
4139 current network addresses.
4140
4141 *** New function `network-interface-info'.
4142
4143 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
4144 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4145
4146 *** Deleting a network process with `delete-process' calls the sentinel.
4147
4148 The status message passed to the sentinel for a deleted network
4149 process is "deleted". The message passed to the sentinel when the
4150 connection is closed by the remote peer has been changed to
4151 "connection broken by remote peer".
4152
4153 ** Using window objects:
4154
4155 +++
4156 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4157
4158 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
4159 header line.
4160
4161 +++
4162 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4163
4164 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line
4165 or the header line.
4166
4167 +++
4168 *** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4169
4170 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4171 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4172 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4173 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4174 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4175
4176 +++
4177 *** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
4178 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
4179 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
4180 the mode line.
4181
4182 +++
4183 *** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
4184 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
4185
4186 +++
4187 *** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
4188 selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
4189 It saves and restores the current buffer, too.
4190
4191 +++
4192 *** `select-window' takes an optional second argument NORECORD.
4193
4194 This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
4195
4196 +++
4197 *** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
4198 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4199 by calling `select-window'. It also saves and restores the current
4200 buffer.
4201
4202 +++
4203 *** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4204
4205 If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4206 and scroll-bar settings.
4207
4208 +++
4209 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
4210
4211 *** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
4212 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
4213
4214 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4215 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
4216
4217 *** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4218 or restores a built-in one to its default value.
4219
4220 *** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' specifies the face to be
4221 used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is automatically merged
4222 with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face should only specify the
4223 foreground color of the bitmap.
4224
4225 *** There are new display properties, `left-fringe' and `right-fringe',
4226 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4227 bitmap of the display line.
4228
4229 Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
4230 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4231 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4232 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4233 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4234
4235 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4236 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
4237
4238 ** Other window fringe features:
4239
4240 +++
4241 *** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
4242
4243 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4244 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4245 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4246 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
4247
4248 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4249 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4250 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4251 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
4252 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4253 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
4254
4255 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4256 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4257 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4258 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4259
4260 +++
4261 *** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
4262
4263 **** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
4264 position settings.
4265
4266 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4267 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4268 `set-window-fringes'.
4269
4270 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4271 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4272 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4273 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4274
4275 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4276 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4277 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4278 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4279 an update of the display margins.
4280
4281 **** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
4282 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4283
4284 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4285 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4286 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4287 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4288 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4289 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4290 of the display margins.
4291
4292 ** Redisplay features:
4293
4294 +++
4295 *** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
4296
4297 +++
4298 *** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4299 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4300 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4301 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4302 forcing an explicit window update.
4303
4304 +++
4305 *** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
4306 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4307 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
4308
4309 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
4310 does that, this value cannot be accurate.
4311
4312 +++
4313 *** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4314 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
4315
4316 It contains a list of varibles which contain overlay arrow position
4317 markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
4318
4319 Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4320 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4321 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4322 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4323 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4324 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
4325
4326 +++
4327 *** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
4328
4329 A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4330 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
4331
4332 If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4333 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4334 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4335 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4336 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
4337
4338 If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4339 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4340 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
4341
4342 If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4343 height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4344 the given value.
4345
4346 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4347 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4348 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
4349
4350 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4351 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
4352
4353 If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4354 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4355 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4356 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4357 exactly that many pixels high.
4358
4359 If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4360 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4361 overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4362 the `line-spacing' variable.
4363
4364 If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4365 is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
4366
4367 +++
4368 *** The buffer local `line-spacing' variable can now have a float value,
4369 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
4370
4371 +++
4372 *** Enhancements to stretch display properties
4373
4374 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4375 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
4376 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
4377
4378 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4379 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4380 are supported:
4381
4382 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4383 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4384 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4385 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4386 | scroll-bar | text
4387 POS ::= left | center | right
4388 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4389 OP ::= + | -
4390
4391 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4392 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4393 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4394 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4395 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4396 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4397 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4398 the image.
4399
4400 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4401 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4402 corresponding area of the window.
4403
4404 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4405 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4406 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4407 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4408 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4409 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4410 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
4411 the width of the area.
4412
4413 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4414 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
4415
4416 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4417 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4418 header line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
4419
4420 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4421 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4422 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4423 height) of the specified image.
4424
4425 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4426 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
4427
4428 +++
4429 *** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4430 text property string that may be present at the current window
4431 position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4432 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
4433
4434 +++
4435 *** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4436 supported on text terminals.
4437
4438 +++
4439 *** Support for displaying image slices
4440
4441 **** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4442 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
4443
4444 **** Function `insert-image' has new optional fourth arg to
4445 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
4446
4447 **** New function `insert-sliced-image' inserts a given image as a
4448 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
4449
4450 +++
4451 *** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
4452
4453 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4454 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4455 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4456 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4457 A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4458 and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4459 A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4460 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
4461
4462 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4463 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4464 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4465 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4466 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable `void-area-text-pointer'
4467 for possible pointer shapes.
4468
4469 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4470 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4471 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
4472
4473 ** Mouse pointer features:
4474
4475 +++ (lispref)
4476 ??? (man)
4477 *** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4478 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4479 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4480 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4481 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
4482
4483 +++
4484 *** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
4485 :pointer image property.
4486
4487 +++
4488 *** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
4489 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
4490
4491 ** Mouse event enhancements:
4492
4493 +++
4494 *** Mouse events for clicks on window fringes now specify `left-fringe'
4495 or `right-fringe' as the area.
4496
4497 +++
4498 *** All mouse events now include a buffer position regardless of where
4499 you clicked. For mouse clicks in window margins and fringes, this is
4500 a sensible buffer position corresponding to the surrounding text.
4501
4502 +++
4503 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
4504
4505 +++
4506 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
4507
4508 +++
4509 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
4510 text area).
4511
4512 +++
4513 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types
4514 and all areas.
4515
4516 +++
4517 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns the actual glyph coordinates
4518 of the mouse event position.
4519
4520 +++
4521 *** Mouse events can now indicate an image object clicked on.
4522
4523 +++
4524 *** Mouse events include relative X and Y pixel coordinates relative to
4525 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
4526
4527 +++
4528 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
4529 (image or character) clicked on.
4530
4531 +++
4532 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', 'posn-object-width-height'.
4533
4534 These return the image or string object of a mouse click, the X and Y
4535 pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner of that object, and
4536 the total width and height of that object.
4537
4538 ** Text property and overlay changes:
4539
4540 +++
4541 *** Arguments for `remove-overlays' are now optional, so that you can
4542 remove all overlays in the buffer with just (remove-overlays).
4543
4544 +++
4545 *** New variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4546
4547 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
4548 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
4549 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
4550 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
4551
4552 +++
4553 *** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
4554 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
4555 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
4556 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
4557 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
4558
4559 +++
4560 *** The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties'.
4561
4562 It is like `remove-text-properties' except that it takes a list of
4563 property names as argument rather than a property list.
4564
4565 ** Face changes
4566
4567 +++
4568 *** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
4569 the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
4570 define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
4571 look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
4572 is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
4573 makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
4574
4575 +++
4576 *** New function `display-supports-face-attributes-p' can be used to test
4577 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
4578
4579 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
4580 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
4581 defined with `defface'.
4582
4583 ---
4584 *** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4585 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
4586 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4587 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4588 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
4589
4590 +++
4591 *** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
4592 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
4593 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
4594 by them).
4595
4596 +++
4597 *** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
4598 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
4599 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
4600 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
4601 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
4602
4603 ---
4604 *** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
4605 whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
4606 not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
4607
4608 +++
4609 *** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', `face-stipple'.
4610
4611 These now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how
4612 face inheritance is used when determining the value of a face
4613 attribute.
4614
4615 +++
4616 *** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
4617 help with handling relative face attributes.
4618
4619 +++
4620 *** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
4621
4622 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
4623 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
4624 releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
4625 so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
4626 `face' properties.
4627
4628 ---
4629 *** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
4630 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
4631
4632 ** Font-Lock changes:
4633
4634 +++
4635 *** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
4636
4637 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
4638 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
4639 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
4640 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4641
4642 +++
4643 *** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
4644
4645 **** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
4646 form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
4647 properties than `face'.
4648
4649 **** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
4650 extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
4651
4652 ---
4653 *** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
4654
4655 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
4656 (see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
4657 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
4658 depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
4659 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
4660
4661 s{
4662 foo
4663 }{
4664 bar
4665 }e
4666
4667 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
4668 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
4669 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
4670 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
4671
4672 ** Major mode mechanism changes:
4673
4674 +++
4675 *** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
4676 precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
4677 declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
4678 var `magic-mode-alist'.
4679
4680 +++
4681 *** Use the new function `run-mode-hooks' to run the major mode's mode hook.
4682
4683 +++
4684 *** All major mode functions should now run the new normal hook
4685 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode
4686 hooks. `run-mode-hooks' does this automatically.
4687
4688 ---
4689 *** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
4690 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
4691 it in that buffer.
4692
4693 +++
4694 *** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
4695 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
4696 the language.
4697
4698 +++
4699 *** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
4700 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
4701
4702 +++
4703 *** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
4704 are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
4705 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
4706
4707 ** Minor mode changes:
4708
4709 +++
4710 *** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
4711 and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
4712
4713 +++
4714 *** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
4715
4716 +++
4717 *** `define-global-minor-mode'.
4718
4719 This is a new name for what was formerly called
4720 `easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
4721
4722 ** Command loop changes:
4723
4724 +++
4725 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
4726 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' to do: it returns t if the
4727 calling function was called through `call-interactively'.
4728
4729 Only use this when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
4730 INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
4731
4732 +++
4733 *** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
4734
4735 If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
4736 called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
4737 macros.
4738
4739 +++
4740 *** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
4741 within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
4742 covered by an image or composition property.
4743
4744 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
4745 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
4746 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
4747 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
4748 `post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
4749
4750 +++
4751 *** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
4752 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
4753 During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
4754 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
4755 the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
4756
4757 +++
4758 *** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
4759 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
4760 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
4761
4762 +++
4763 *** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
4764 when it receives a request from emacsclient.
4765
4766 ** Lisp file loading changes:
4767
4768 +++
4769 *** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
4770 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
4771 current file redefined it).
4772
4773 +++
4774 *** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
4775 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
4776
4777 +++
4778 *** The function `symbol-file' can now search specifically for function,
4779 variable or face definitions.
4780
4781 +++
4782 *** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
4783 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
4784 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
4785
4786 ---
4787 *** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
4788 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
4789 than 3 levels of nesting.
4790
4791 +++
4792 ** Byte compiler changes:
4793
4794 *** The byte compiler now displays the actual line and character
4795 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
4796 warning and error messages have been brought into line with GNU standards
4797 for these. As a result, you can use next-error and friends on the
4798 compilation output buffer.
4799
4800 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
4801 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
4802
4803 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
4804 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
4805 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
4806 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
4807 forms:
4808
4809 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
4810 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
4811
4812 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
4813 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
4814 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
4815 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
4816 macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
4817 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
4818
4819 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
4820 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
4821 Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
4822 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
4823 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
4824 you anything.
4825
4826 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in Lisp files is now obeyed.
4827
4828 ---
4829 *** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
4830 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
4831 (require 'cl) when loaded.
4832
4833 ** Frame operations:
4834
4835 +++
4836 *** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
4837
4838 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
4839 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
4840
4841 +++
4842 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
4843 for all (existing and future) frames.
4844
4845 +++
4846 *** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
4847 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
4848 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
4849 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
4850
4851 +++
4852 *** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
4853 the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
4854
4855 ** Mule changes:
4856
4857 +++
4858 *** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
4859
4860 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
4861 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
4862 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
4863 now:
4864
4865 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
4866
4867 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
4868 the time it takes to convert the format.
4869
4870 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
4871 wasteful.
4872
4873 ---
4874 *** `set-buffer-file-coding-system' now takes an additional argument,
4875 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
4876
4877 +++
4878 *** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
4879 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
4880 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
4881 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
4882
4883 ---
4884 *** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
4885 of one coding system from another coding system.
4886
4887 ---
4888 *** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
4889 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
4890 parts, e.g. utf-16.
4891
4892 +++
4893 *** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
4894 it is read from a file without decoding.
4895
4896 ---
4897 *** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
4898 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
4899
4900 ---
4901 *** New function `quail-find-key' returns a list of keys to type in the
4902 current input method to input a character.
4903
4904 ** Mode line changes:
4905
4906 +++
4907 *** New function `format-mode-line'.
4908
4909 This returns the mode line or header line of the selected (or a
4910 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
4911
4912 +++
4913 *** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
4914 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
4915
4916 +++
4917 *** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
4918 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
4919 line.
4920
4921 +++
4922 *** Mouse-face on mode-line (and header-line) is now supported.
4923
4924 ** Menu manipulation changes:
4925
4926 ---
4927 *** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
4928 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
4929 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
4930 several versions ago.
4931
4932 ---
4933 *** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
4934 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
4935 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
4936
4937 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
4938 made with easy-menu.
4939
4940 ---
4941 *** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
4942 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
4943 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
4944 need to have a name.
4945
4946 ** Operating system access:
4947
4948 +++
4949 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
4950 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
4951
4952 +++
4953 *** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
4954 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
4955 accepts a float as UID parameter.
4956
4957 +++
4958 *** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
4959
4960 ---
4961 *** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
4962 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
4963 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
4964
4965 ---
4966 *** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
4967 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
4968
4969 ** Miscellaneous:
4970
4971 +++
4972 *** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
4973
4974 `find-file-hooks' to `find-file-hook',
4975 `find-file-not-found-hooks' to `find-file-not-found-functions',
4976 `write-file-hooks' to `write-file-functions',
4977 `write-contents-hooks' to `write-contents-functions',
4978 `x-lost-selection-hooks' to `x-lost-selection-functions',
4979 `x-sent-selection-hooks' to `x-sent-selection-functions',
4980 `delete-frame-hook' to `delete-frame-functions'.
4981
4982 In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
4983
4984 +++
4985 *** local-write-file-hooks is marked obsolete
4986
4987 Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
4988
4989 ---
4990 *** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
4991 running under X.
4992
4993 ** GC changes:
4994
4995 +++
4996 *** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
4997 on garbage collection.
4998
4999 +++
5000 *** The normal hook `post-gc-hook' is run at the end of garbage collection.
5001
5002 The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
5003 \f
5004 * New Packages for Lisp Programming in Emacs 22.1
5005
5006 +++
5007 ** The new library button.el implements simple and fast `clickable
5008 buttons' in emacs buffers. Buttons are much lighter-weight than the
5009 `widgets' implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that
5010 doesn't require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for
5011 such things as help and apropos buffers.
5012
5013 ---
5014 ** The new library tree-widget.el provides a widget to display a set
5015 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
5016 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
5017
5018 +++
5019 ** The new library bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
5020 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
5021 data structures.
5022
5023 ---
5024 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
5025 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
5026
5027 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
5028 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
5029 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
5030 commands.
5031
5032 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
5033 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
5034 SQL buffer.
5035
5036 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
5037 (function (lambda ()
5038 (master-mode t)
5039 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5040 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
5041 (function (lambda ()
5042 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5043
5044 +++
5045 ** The new library benchmark.el does timing measurements on Lisp code.
5046
5047 This includes measuring garbage collection time.
5048
5049 +++
5050 ** The new library testcover.el does test coverage checking.
5051
5052 This is so you can tell whether you've tested all paths in your Lisp
5053 code. It works with edebug.
5054
5055 The function `testcover-start' instruments all functions in a given
5056 file. Then test your code. The function `testcover-mark-all' adds
5057 overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to show where coverage
5058 is lacking. The command `testcover-next-mark' (bind it to a key!)
5059 will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
5060
5061 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
5062 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
5063 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
5064 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
5065 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
5066 value, such as (setq x 14).
5067
5068 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
5069 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
5070 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
5071 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
5072 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
5073 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
5074 \f
5075 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
5076
5077 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
5078 been added.
5079
5080 \f
5081 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
5082
5083 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
5084 with Custom.
5085
5086 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
5087 as mule-utf-8.
5088
5089 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
5090 in UTF-8 locales).
5091
5092 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
5093 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
5094 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
5095 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
5096 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
5097 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
5098 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
5099 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
5100 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
5101 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
5102
5103 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
5104 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
5105
5106 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
5107 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
5108 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
5109 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
5110 contrary to the compound text specification.
5111
5112 \f
5113 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
5114
5115 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
5116
5117 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
5118
5119 \f
5120 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
5121
5122 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
5123
5124 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
5125 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
5126 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
5127 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
5128 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
5129
5130 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
5131 were changed.
5132
5133 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
5134 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
5135
5136 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
5137 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
5138 instead of using default-major-mode.
5139
5140 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
5141 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
5142 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
5143 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
5144 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
5145 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
5146 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
5147
5148 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
5149 NEWS.
5150
5151 \f
5152 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
5153
5154 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
5155 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
5156 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
5157
5158 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
5159 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
5160
5161 \f
5162 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
5163
5164 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
5165 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
5166 charsets in this release.
5167
5168 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
5169
5170 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
5171
5172 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
5173 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
5174 to list them.
5175
5176 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
5177 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
5178 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
5179 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
5180 necessary changes to unexec.
5181
5182 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
5183 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
5184
5185 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
5186 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
5187
5188 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
5189 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
5190
5191 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
5192 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
5193 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
5194 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
5195 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
5196
5197 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
5198 new display features described below.
5199
5200 \f
5201 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
5202
5203 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
5204
5205 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
5206 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
5207 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
5208 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
5209 the text.
5210
5211 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
5212
5213 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
5214 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
5215 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
5216 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
5217 specify a font.
5218
5219 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
5220 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
5221 under Lisp changes, below.
5222
5223 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
5224
5225 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
5226 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
5227 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
5228 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
5229 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
5230 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
5231 on terminals.
5232
5233 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
5234 supported on character terminals.
5235
5236 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
5237 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
5238 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
5239 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
5240
5241 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
5242
5243 ** Sound support
5244
5245 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
5246 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
5247 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
5248 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
5249 sound support.
5250
5251 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
5252
5253 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5254 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5255 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5256 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5257
5258 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5259
5260 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5261 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5262 specifies a number of lines.
5263
5264 Default is 0.25.
5265
5266 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5267
5268 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5269 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5270 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5271 again.
5272
5273 Default is `grow-only'.
5274
5275 ** LessTif support.
5276
5277 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5278 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5279
5280 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5281
5282 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5283 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5284 non-nil.
5285
5286 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5287
5288 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5289 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5290 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5291
5292 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5293
5294 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5295 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5296 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5297 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5298 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5299 Emacs.
5300
5301 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5302 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5303 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5304 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5305 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5306 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5307
5308 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5309 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5310 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5311 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5312 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5313 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5314
5315 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5316 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5317 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5318 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5319 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5320
5321 ** Tool bar support.
5322
5323 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5324 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5325 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5326 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5327 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5328 icons will be used.
5329
5330 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5331 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5332
5333 ** Tooltips.
5334
5335 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5336 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5337 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5338
5339 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5340 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5341 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5342 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5343
5344 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5345
5346 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5347 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5348 customized.
5349
5350 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5351 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5352 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5353 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5354 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5355
5356 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5357 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5358 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5359 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5360 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5361 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5362
5363 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5364 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5365 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5366 customizing face `fringe'.
5367
5368 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5369 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5370 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5371 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5372 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5373 the window to be partially obscured.)
5374
5375 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5376 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5377 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5378 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5379
5380 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5381
5382 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5383 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5384 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5385 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5386 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5387 have enabled one.
5388
5389 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5390
5391 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5392
5393 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5394
5395 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5396 `*') toggles the status.
5397
5398 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5399
5400 ** Hourglass pointer
5401
5402 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5403 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5404
5405 ** Blinking cursor
5406
5407 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5408 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5409 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5410 the group `cursor'.
5411
5412 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5413
5414 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5415 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5416 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5417 details.
5418
5419 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5420 have to do anything to activate it.
5421
5422 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5423
5424 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5425 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5426
5427 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5428 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5429 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5430 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5431 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5432 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5433 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5434 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5435
5436 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5437 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5438 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5439 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5440 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5441 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5442
5443 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5444 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5445
5446 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5447 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5448 buffer by default.
5449
5450 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5451 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5452 beginning and end of the buffer.
5453
5454 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5455 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5456 signaled.
5457
5458 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5459 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5460
5461 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5462 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5463 this behavior.
5464
5465 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
5466 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5467 Emacs dump core.
5468
5469 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5470
5471 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
5472 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
5473 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
5474
5475 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
5476 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
5477 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
5478
5479 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
5480 using that menu.
5481
5482 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
5483
5484 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
5485 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
5486 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
5487 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
5488 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
5489 whitespace.
5490
5491 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
5492 all frames except the selected one.
5493
5494 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5495 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5496
5497 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5498 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5499 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5500 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5501 `Info-use-header-line'.
5502
5503 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5504 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5505 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5506
5507 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5508
5509 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5510 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5511 `fr-drdref.tex'.
5512
5513 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5514 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5515 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5516 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5517
5518 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
5519
5520 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
5521 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5522 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
5523 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
5524
5525 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
5526 point in a pop-up window.
5527
5528 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
5529 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
5530 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
5531
5532 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
5533 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
5534
5535 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
5536 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
5537 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
5538 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
5539
5540 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
5541
5542 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5543 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5544
5545 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
5546 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
5547 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
5548
5549 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
5550 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
5551 non-nil.
5552
5553 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
5554 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
5555 file that is already visited under a different name.
5556
5557 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
5558 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
5559
5560 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
5561 and displays information about that.
5562
5563 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
5564 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
5565
5566 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
5567 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
5568 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
5569 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
5570 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
5571 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
5572
5573 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
5574 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
5575
5576 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
5577 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
5578 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
5579 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
5580 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
5581 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
5582 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
5583
5584 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
5585 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
5586
5587 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
5588 system for keyboard input.
5589
5590 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
5591 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
5592 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
5593 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
5594 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
5595 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
5596 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
5597 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
5598 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
5599
5600 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
5601 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
5602
5603 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
5604 displays all characters in that character set.
5605
5606 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
5607 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
5608
5609 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
5610 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
5611 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
5612
5613 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
5614 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
5615 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
5616 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
5617 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
5618 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
5619 and Polish `slash'.
5620
5621 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
5622 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
5623 of the tutorial.
5624
5625 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
5626 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
5627 Lisp Coding Convention".
5628
5629 new command old-binding
5630 --- ------- -----------
5631 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
5632 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
5633 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
5634
5635 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
5636 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
5637 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
5638
5639 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
5640 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
5641 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
5642 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
5643 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
5644 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
5645
5646 ** There are new Leim input methods.
5647 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
5648 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
5649 package.
5650
5651 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
5652 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
5653 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
5654 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
5655 "`", you must type "=q".
5656
5657 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
5658 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
5659 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
5660 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
5661 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
5662 on.
5663
5664 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
5665 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
5666 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
5667 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
5668
5669 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
5670 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
5671 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
5672 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
5673
5674 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
5675 on the display using several methods
5676
5677 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
5678 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
5679 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
5680
5681 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
5682 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
5683
5684 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
5685
5686 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
5687 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
5688
5689 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
5690 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
5691 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
5692 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
5693
5694 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
5695 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
5696 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
5697
5698 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
5699 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
5700
5701 ** New X resources recognized
5702
5703 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
5704 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
5705 is useful for debugging X problems.
5706
5707 Example:
5708
5709 emacs.synchronous: true
5710
5711 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
5712 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
5713 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
5714 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
5715 visual class names are
5716
5717 TrueColor
5718 PseudoColor
5719 DirectColor
5720 StaticColor
5721 GrayScale
5722 StaticGray
5723
5724 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
5725 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
5726 meaning.
5727
5728 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
5729 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
5730 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
5731 visual.
5732
5733 Example:
5734
5735 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
5736
5737 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
5738 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
5739 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
5740 resource values are `true' or `on'.
5741
5742 Example:
5743
5744 emacs.privateColormap: true
5745
5746 ** Faces and frame parameters.
5747
5748 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
5749 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
5750 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
5751 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
5752 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
5753 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
5754 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
5755
5756 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
5757 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
5758 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
5759 `default' face and vice versa.
5760
5761 ** New face `menu'.
5762
5763 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
5764
5765 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
5766
5767 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
5768 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
5769 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
5770 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
5771
5772 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
5773 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
5774 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
5775
5776 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
5777 `ScreenGamma'.
5778
5779 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
5780
5781 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
5782 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
5783 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
5784 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
5785
5786 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
5787
5788 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
5789
5790 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
5791
5792 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
5793 LessTif/Motif one.
5794
5795 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
5796 LessTif and Motif.
5797
5798 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
5799
5800 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
5801 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
5802 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
5803
5804 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
5805 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
5806
5807 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
5808 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
5809 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
5810
5811 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
5812
5813 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
5814 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
5815 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5816 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
5817
5818 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
5819 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
5820 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5821 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
5822
5823 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
5824 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
5825 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
5826 buffers.
5827
5828 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
5829
5830 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
5831 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
5832 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
5833
5834 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
5835 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
5836 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
5837 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
5838 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
5839 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
5840
5841 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
5842
5843 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
5844 notably at the end of lines.
5845
5846 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
5847 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
5848
5849 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
5850
5851 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
5852 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
5853
5854 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
5855 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
5856 after each match to get the replacement text.
5857
5858 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
5859 you edit the replacement string.
5860
5861 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
5862 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
5863 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
5864
5865 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
5866
5867 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
5868 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
5869
5870 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
5871 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
5872 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
5873 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
5874
5875 --
5876 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
5877 read mail from the menu etc.
5878
5879 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
5880 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
5881 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
5882 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
5883
5884 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
5885 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
5886
5887 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
5888 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
5889 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
5890 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
5891 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
5892 of Emacs.
5893
5894 ** Customize changes
5895
5896 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
5897 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
5898 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
5899 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
5900 earlier versions of Emacs.
5901
5902 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
5903 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
5904 default).
5905
5906 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5907 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
5908 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
5909 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
5910 file.
5911
5912 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5913 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
5914 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
5915 already in your init file.
5916
5917 ** New features in evaluation commands
5918
5919 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
5920 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
5921 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
5922 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
5923 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
5924
5925 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
5926 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
5927 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
5928 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
5929 printed).
5930
5931 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
5932 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
5933
5934 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
5935 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
5936
5937 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
5938 code when called with a prefix argument.
5939
5940 ** CC mode changes.
5941
5942 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
5943 current user setups (although it's believed that these
5944 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
5945 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
5946 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
5947 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
5948 release.
5949
5950 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
5951 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
5952 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
5953 confusion.
5954
5955 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
5956 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
5957 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
5958 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
5959
5960 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
5961 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
5962
5963 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
5964 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
5965
5966 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
5967 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
5968 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
5969 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
5970
5971 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
5972 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
5973 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
5974 earlier statement. An example:
5975
5976 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
5977 if (a[i])
5978 res += a[i]->offset;
5979 else
5980
5981 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
5982 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
5983 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
5984 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
5985 the preceding "if".
5986
5987 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
5988 by default.
5989
5990 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
5991 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
5992 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
5993 documentation or other natural language text.
5994
5995 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
5996 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
5997 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
5998 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
5999 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
6000 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
6001 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
6002
6003 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
6004 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
6005 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
6006 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
6007
6008 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
6009 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
6010 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
6011 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
6012 Pike mode only.
6013
6014 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
6015 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
6016 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
6017 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
6018 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
6019 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
6020 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
6021 is reported afterwards.
6022
6023 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
6024 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
6025 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
6026
6027 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
6028 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
6029 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
6030 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
6031 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
6032 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
6033 groundwork.
6034
6035 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
6036 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
6037 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
6038 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
6039 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
6040 have to bother.
6041
6042 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
6043 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
6044 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
6045 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
6046 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
6047 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
6048
6049 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
6050 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
6051 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
6052 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
6053 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
6054 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
6055 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
6056 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
6057
6058 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
6059 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
6060 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
6061 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
6062 above.
6063
6064 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
6065 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
6066 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
6067 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
6068 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
6069 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
6070 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
6071 function documentation for more info.
6072
6073 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
6074 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
6075 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
6076 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
6077 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
6078 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
6079 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
6080 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
6081
6082 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
6083
6084 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
6085 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
6086
6087 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
6088 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
6089 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
6090 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
6091 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
6092 style system.
6093
6094 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
6095 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
6096 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
6097 as far as possible.
6098
6099 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
6100 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
6101 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
6102 chapter about this in the manual.
6103
6104 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
6105 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
6106 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
6107 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
6108 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
6109
6110 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
6111 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
6112 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
6113
6114 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
6115 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
6116
6117 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
6118 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
6119 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
6120 inside CC Mode.
6121
6122 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
6123 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
6124 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
6125 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
6126 cc-mode/).
6127
6128 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
6129 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
6130 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
6131 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
6132 they were before the filling.
6133
6134 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
6135 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
6136 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
6137 literals.
6138
6139 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
6140 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
6141 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
6142 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
6143 this function.
6144
6145 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
6146 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
6147 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
6148 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
6149 Thanks to Eric Eide.
6150
6151 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
6152 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
6153 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
6154
6155 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
6156
6157 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
6158 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
6159 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
6160 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
6161
6162 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
6163 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
6164 the column specified by comment-column.
6165
6166 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
6167 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
6168 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
6169 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
6170 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
6171 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
6172
6173 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
6174 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
6175 arguments.
6176
6177 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
6178
6179 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
6180 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
6181 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
6182 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
6183 Provan).
6184
6185 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
6186
6187 ** Dired changes
6188
6189 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
6190 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
6191 is, delete only empty directories.
6192
6193 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
6194 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
6195 copy directories recursively.
6196
6197 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
6198 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
6199 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
6200
6201 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
6202 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
6203 directory.
6204
6205 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
6206 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
6207 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
6208 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
6209 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
6210
6211 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
6212 from ls switches.
6213
6214 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
6215 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
6216 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
6217 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
6218
6219 ** Gnus changes.
6220
6221 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
6222 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
6223 internationalization and mail-fetching.
6224
6225 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
6226 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
6227
6228 If you used procmail like in
6229
6230 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
6231 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
6232 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
6233 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
6234
6235 this now has changed to
6236
6237 (setq mail-sources
6238 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
6239 :suffix ".in")))
6240
6241 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
6242 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
6243
6244 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
6245 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
6246 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
6247 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
6248
6249 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
6250 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
6251 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
6252
6253 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6254 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6255 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6256 now just a compatibility layer.
6257
6258 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6259 Gnus facilities.
6260
6261 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6262 called to position point.
6263
6264 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6265 summary buffers and NOV files.
6266
6267 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6268 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6269
6270 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6271 subtly different manner.
6272
6273 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6274 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6275 ever-changing layouts.
6276
6277 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6278
6279 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6280
6281 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6282
6283 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6284 macros
6285
6286 Key binding Macro
6287 -------------------------
6288 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6289 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6290 C-c C-c u @uref
6291 C-c C-c q @quotation
6292 C-c C-c m @email
6293 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6294 M-RET @item
6295
6296 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6297
6298 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6299
6300 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6301 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6302 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6303
6304 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6305
6306 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6307 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6308 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6309 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6310 buffers to kill, as before.
6311
6312 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6313 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6314 this way.
6315
6316 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6317 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6318
6319 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6320
6321 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6322 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6323 use. Default is 1000.
6324
6325 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6326 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6327
6328 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6329
6330 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6331
6332 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6333 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6334 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6335 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6336
6337 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6338 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6339 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6340 the open block.
6341
6342 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6343 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6344 the normal block-hiding function.
6345
6346 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6347
6348 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6349 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6350 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6351 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6352
6353 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6354 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6355
6356 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6357
6358 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6359 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6360 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6361
6362 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6363 current buffer.
6364
6365 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6366 in a log file.
6367
6368 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6369 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6370 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6371 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6372 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6373 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6374
6375 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6376
6377 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6378
6379 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6380 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6381
6382 ** Changes in Font Lock
6383
6384 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6385 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6386
6387 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6388 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6389
6390 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6391 the face used for each string/comment.
6392
6393 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6394 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6395
6396 ** Changes to Shell mode
6397
6398 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6399 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6400 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6401 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6402
6403 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6404
6405 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6406 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6407
6408 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6409 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6410 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6411 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6412 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6413 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6414
6415 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6416 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6417 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6418 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6419 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6420 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6421 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6422 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6423
6424 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6425 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6426
6427 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6428 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6429 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6430
6431 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6432 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6433 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6434
6435 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6436 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6437 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6438
6439 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6440 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6441 argument, it appends to the file.
6442
6443 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6444 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6445 compatibility.
6446
6447 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6448 ring (history).
6449
6450 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6451 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6452 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6453
6454 ** Changes to Rmail mode
6455
6456 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6457 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6458 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6459 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6460 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6461 as correspondent.
6462
6463 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6464 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6465 regexp matching your mail addresses.
6466
6467 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6468 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6469 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6470 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6471 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
6472
6473 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
6474 like `j'.
6475
6476 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
6477 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
6478 digest message.
6479
6480 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
6481 in which folder to put messages automatically.
6482
6483 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
6484 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
6485 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
6486
6487 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
6488 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
6489
6490 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
6491 use the -f option when sending mail.
6492
6493 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6494 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6495 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6496 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6497 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6498 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6499
6500 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6501 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6502 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6503
6504 ** Changes to TeX mode
6505
6506 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6507 `latex-mode'.
6508
6509 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6510
6511 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6512
6513 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6514
6515 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6516
6517 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6518 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6519 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6520 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6521 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6522 can be edited from that buffer.
6523
6524 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
6525 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
6526 `A' to use all marked entries).
6527
6528 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
6529 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
6530
6531 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
6532 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
6533 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
6534 been cited.
6535
6536 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
6537 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
6538 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
6539 in column 1 are always made leaves.
6540
6541 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
6542 has the following new features:
6543
6544 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
6545 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
6546 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
6547 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
6548
6549 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
6550 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
6551 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
6552 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
6553 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
6554 defaults to 1.
6555
6556 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
6557 file names.
6558
6559 ** Ispell changes
6560
6561 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
6562 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
6563 spell-checks the current buffer.
6564
6565 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
6566 added.
6567
6568 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
6569 correction is made and re-checked.
6570
6571 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
6572
6573 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
6574 cases.
6575
6576 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
6577 on syntax errors.
6578
6579 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
6580 end of the buffer.
6581
6582 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6583
6584 ** Makefile mode changes
6585
6586 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
6587
6588 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
6589 Fontlock mode is active.
6590
6591 ** Isearch changes
6592
6593 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
6594 so that searches can be resumed.
6595
6596 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
6597 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
6598 that started the search.
6599
6600 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
6601 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6602
6603 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
6604
6605 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
6606 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
6607 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
6608 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
6609 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
6610 `secondary-selection'.
6611
6612 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
6613 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
6614 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
6615 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
6616 usual snappy response.
6617
6618 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
6619 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
6620 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
6621 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
6622
6623 ** VC Changes
6624
6625 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
6626 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
6627 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
6628 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
6629 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
6630 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
6631 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
6632 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
6633 file is registered in that backend.
6634
6635 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
6636 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
6637 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
6638 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
6639 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
6640 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
6641
6642 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
6643 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
6644 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
6645 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
6646 where it doesn't make sense.)
6647
6648 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
6649 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
6650 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
6651
6652 *** General Changes
6653
6654 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
6655 checks are always done now.
6656
6657 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
6658 operations.
6659
6660 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
6661 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
6662 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
6663
6664 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
6665 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
6666 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
6667 the working file (``merge news'').
6668
6669 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6670 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
6671 downwards.
6672
6673 *** Multiple Backends
6674
6675 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
6676 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
6677 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
6678 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
6679 local RCS archives.
6680
6681 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
6682 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
6683 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
6684 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
6685
6686 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
6687 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
6688 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
6689 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
6690 current revision number from the more remote backend.
6691
6692 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
6693 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
6694 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
6695 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
6696
6697 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
6698 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
6699 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
6700 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
6701
6702 *** Changes for CVS
6703
6704 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
6705 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
6706 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
6707 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
6708 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
6709 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
6710 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
6711
6712 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
6713 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
6714 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
6715 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
6716 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
6717 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
6718 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
6719 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
6720 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
6721 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
6722 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
6723 name.)
6724
6725 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
6726 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
6727 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
6728 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
6729 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
6730 entire directory tree.
6731
6732 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
6733 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
6734 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
6735 "watched" by other developers.)
6736
6737 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6738 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
6739 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
6740 starting at the given directory.
6741
6742 *** Lisp Changes in VC
6743
6744 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
6745 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
6746 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
6747 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
6748 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
6749 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
6750 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
6751 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
6752 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
6753
6754 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
6755 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
6756 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
6757 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
6758
6759 ** New modes and packages
6760
6761 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
6762 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
6763 the default is not applicable.
6764
6765 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
6766 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
6767 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
6768
6769 Features are:
6770
6771 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
6772 drawn, like this: | \ /
6773 --+-- X
6774 | / \
6775
6776 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
6777 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
6778 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
6779 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
6780 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
6781 you are drawing.
6782
6783 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
6784 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
6785
6786 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
6787 flood-filling.
6788
6789 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
6790 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
6791 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
6792 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
6793
6794 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
6795 also do without the mouse.
6796
6797 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
6798 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
6799 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
6800 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
6801 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
6802
6803 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
6804
6805 lines straight-lines
6806 rectangles squares
6807 poly-lines straight poly-lines
6808 ellipses circles
6809 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
6810 spray-can setting size for spraying
6811 vaporize line vaporize lines
6812 erase characters erase rectangles
6813
6814 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
6815 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
6816 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
6817 drawing.
6818
6819 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
6820 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
6821 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
6822 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
6823
6824 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
6825 can be turned off).
6826
6827 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
6828 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
6829 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
6830 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
6831 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
6832 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
6833 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
6834 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
6835 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
6836
6837 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
6838 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
6839 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
6840 on certain projects.
6841
6842 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
6843 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
6844
6845 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
6846
6847 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
6848 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
6849 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
6850 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
6851 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
6852 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
6853 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
6854 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
6855
6856 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
6857 Emacs is idle.
6858
6859 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
6860 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
6861
6862 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
6863 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
6864
6865 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
6866 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
6867 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
6868 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
6869 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
6870
6871 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
6872 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
6873 separate Texinfo file.
6874
6875 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
6876 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
6877 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
6878 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
6879 enter check-in log messages.
6880
6881 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
6882 without invoking external programs.
6883
6884 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
6885 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
6886 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
6887 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
6888 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
6889
6890 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
6891 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
6892
6893 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
6894 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
6895
6896 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
6897 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
6898 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
6899 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
6900 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
6901 single step.
6902
6903 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
6904 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
6905 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
6906 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
6907
6908 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
6909 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
6910 actually modifying content of a buffer.
6911
6912 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
6913 PostScript.
6914
6915 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
6916
6917 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
6918
6919 ; comment (until end of line)
6920 A non-terminal
6921 "C" terminal
6922 ?C? special
6923 $A default non-terminal
6924 $"C" default terminal
6925 $?C? default special
6926 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
6927 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
6928 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
6929 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
6930 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
6931 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
6932 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
6933 C+ one or more occurrences of C
6934 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
6935 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
6936 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
6937 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
6938 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
6939 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6940 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6941
6942 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
6943
6944 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
6945 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
6946 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
6947 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
6948 equal signs of assignments.
6949
6950 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
6951 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
6952
6953 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
6954 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
6955 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
6956
6957 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
6958
6959 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
6960 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
6961 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
6962 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
6963 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
6964 which answers different needs.
6965
6966 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
6967 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
6968 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
6969 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
6970 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
6971 to be enabled.
6972
6973 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
6974 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
6975
6976 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
6977
6978 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
6979 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
6980 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
6981
6982 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
6983
6984 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
6985 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
6986 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
6987 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
6988 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
6989 and background colors.
6990
6991 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
6992 Pascal) language.
6993
6994 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
6995 the text at point.
6996
6997 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
6998
6999 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
7000
7001 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
7002 whitespace in a file.
7003
7004 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
7005 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
7006 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
7007 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
7008 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
7009 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
7010 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
7011
7012 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
7013
7014 Here is an example of columns:
7015
7016 horse apple bus
7017 dog pineapple car EXTRA
7018 porcupine strawberry airplane
7019
7020 Doing the following settings:
7021
7022 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
7023 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
7024 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
7025 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
7026
7027
7028 Selecting the lines above and typing:
7029
7030 M-x delimit-columns-region
7031
7032 It results:
7033
7034 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
7035 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
7036 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
7037
7038 delim-col has the following options:
7039
7040 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
7041 before all columns.
7042
7043 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
7044 between each column.
7045
7046 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
7047 after all columns.
7048
7049 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
7050 each column.
7051
7052 delim-col has the following commands:
7053
7054 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
7055 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
7056
7057 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
7058 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
7059 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
7060 recent file list can be displayed:
7061
7062 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
7063 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
7064 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
7065
7066 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
7067 dynamically change the menu appearance.
7068
7069 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
7070 text.
7071
7072 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
7073 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
7074 specific to Message mode.
7075
7076 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
7077 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
7078 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
7079
7080 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
7081 interface to access directory servers using different directory
7082 protocols. It has a separate manual.
7083
7084 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
7085 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
7086
7087 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
7088
7089 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
7090 minibuffer with completion.
7091
7092 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
7093 with the diary features.
7094
7095 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
7096 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
7097
7098 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
7099 Fill mode.
7100
7101 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
7102 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
7103 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
7104 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
7105
7106 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
7107 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
7108 `.g'.
7109
7110 ** Changes in sort.el
7111
7112 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
7113 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
7114 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
7115 numeric base.
7116
7117 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
7118
7119 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
7120 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
7121 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
7122
7123 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
7124 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
7125
7126 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
7127 output ^M at the end of lines.
7128
7129 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
7130 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
7131
7132 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
7133 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
7134 `(msb-mode 1)'.
7135
7136 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
7137 group.
7138
7139 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
7140 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
7141 are recognized:
7142
7143 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
7144 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
7145 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
7146 nil -- just delete one character.
7147
7148 Default value is `untabify'.
7149
7150 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
7151
7152 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
7153 symbol, not double-quoted.
7154
7155 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
7156 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
7157 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
7158 moved to lisp/obsolete.
7159
7160 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
7161 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
7162 `auto-compression-mode' command.
7163
7164 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
7165 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
7166 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
7167
7168 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
7169 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
7170
7171 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
7172 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
7173
7174 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
7175 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
7176
7177 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
7178 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
7179 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
7180 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
7181 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
7182 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
7183
7184 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
7185 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
7186
7187 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
7188
7189 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
7190 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
7191
7192 ** Shell script mode changes.
7193
7194 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
7195 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
7196 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
7197
7198 ** Etags changes.
7199
7200 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
7201
7202 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
7203 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
7204 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
7205 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
7206 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
7207
7208 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
7209 declarations when given the --declarations option.
7210
7211 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
7212 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
7213
7214 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
7215 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
7216 `template' keywords.
7217
7218 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
7219 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
7220
7221 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
7222 types.
7223
7224 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
7225
7226 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
7227
7228 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
7229 are now tagged.
7230
7231 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
7232
7233 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
7234 variables are tagged.
7235
7236 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
7237
7238 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
7239 for PSWrap.
7240
7241 ** Changes in etags.el
7242
7243 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
7244 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
7245 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
7246
7247 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
7248 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
7249
7250 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
7251 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
7252 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
7253 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7254
7255 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7256
7257 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7258 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7259
7260 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7261
7262 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7263 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7264 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7265
7266 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7267 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7268
7269 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7270 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7271
7272 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7273 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7274 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7275 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7276 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7277
7278 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7279 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7280 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7281
7282 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7283 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7284 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7285
7286 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7287 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7288 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7289
7290 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7291
7292 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7293
7294 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7295 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7296 expression from that list, are not checked.
7297
7298 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7299 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7300 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7301 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7302
7303 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7304
7305 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7306 displays local abbrevs, only.
7307
7308 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7309 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7310
7311 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7312 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7313 is measured in pixels.
7314
7315 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7316 to be visited as images.
7317
7318 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7319 were added to compile.el.
7320
7321 ** Withdrawn packages
7322
7323 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7324 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7325
7326 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7327
7328 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7329
7330 \f
7331 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7332
7333 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7334 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7335 See the sections below for details.
7336
7337 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7338 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7339 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7340 to remove the properties of the copy.
7341
7342 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7343 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7344 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7345 these properties are active.
7346
7347 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7348 ranges may affect some code.
7349
7350 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7351 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7352 make a difference to some code.
7353
7354 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7355 operates on the minibuffer.
7356
7357 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7358 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7359 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7360 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7361 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7362 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7363 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7364 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7365 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7366 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7367 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7368 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7369
7370 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7371 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7372 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7373
7374 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7375 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7376 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7377
7378 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7379 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7380 such as `mapconcat'.
7381
7382 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7383 string.
7384
7385 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7386 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7387 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7388 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7389 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7390 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7391 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7392 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7393
7394 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7395 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7396 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7397 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7398 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7399 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7400 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7401 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7402 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7403 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7404
7405 \f
7406 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7407 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7408
7409 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7410
7411 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
7412 allows the animated display of strings.
7413
7414 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7415 interactive form of a function.
7416
7417 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7418 between custom options. Example:
7419
7420 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7421 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7422 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7423 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7424 :group 'mule
7425 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7426 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7427
7428 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7429 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7430 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7431
7432 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
7433 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7434 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7435 (signal or normal termination).
7436
7437 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7438 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7439
7440 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7441 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7442
7443 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7444 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7445
7446 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
7447
7448 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7449 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7450 being deleted.
7451
7452 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7453
7454 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
7455 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7456 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7457 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7458 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7459 charset.
7460
7461 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7462 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7463 message.
7464
7465 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7466 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7467
7468 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7469 with the more general `:mask' property.
7470
7471 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
7472
7473 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
7474 backslash.
7475
7476 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
7477 is running in batch mode. For example,
7478
7479 (message "%s" (read t))
7480
7481 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
7482 to standard output.
7483
7484 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
7485 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
7486
7487 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
7488 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
7489 frame or window.
7490
7491 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
7492 were added
7493
7494 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
7495
7496 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
7497 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7498
7499 - Function: remq ELT LIST
7500
7501 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7502 comparison is done with `eq'.
7503
7504 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
7505
7506 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
7507 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
7508 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
7509
7510 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7511 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7512 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7513
7514 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7515 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
7516
7517 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7518 function was declared obsolete.
7519
7520 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7521 retained as an alias).
7522
7523 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
7524 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
7525
7526 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
7527
7528 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
7529
7530 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
7531 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
7532 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
7533 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
7534 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
7535 means never include the minibuffer window.
7536
7537 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
7538
7539 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
7540
7541 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
7542
7543 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
7544 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
7545 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
7546 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
7547 returned.
7548
7549 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
7550 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
7551 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
7552 minibuffer even if it is active.
7553
7554 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
7555 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
7556 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
7557 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
7558 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
7559 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
7560
7561 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
7562 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
7563 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
7564 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
7565 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
7566 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
7567 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
7568
7569 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
7570 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
7571 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
7572
7573 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
7574 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
7575 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
7576 Default value is nil.
7577
7578 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
7579 meaning no limit.
7580
7581 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
7582 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
7583 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
7584
7585 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
7586 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
7587 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
7588
7589 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
7590 list of a primitive.
7591
7592 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
7593
7594 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
7595 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
7596 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
7597 than replacing the local map.
7598
7599 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
7600 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
7601 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
7602 instead.
7603
7604 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
7605
7606 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
7607 as promised long ago.
7608
7609 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
7610
7611 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
7612 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
7613 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
7614
7615 \f
7616 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
7617
7618 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
7619 regular expressions.
7620
7621 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
7622
7623 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7624
7625 - Macro: rx SEXP
7626
7627 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7628
7629 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
7630 notation.
7631
7632 STRING
7633 matches string STRING literally.
7634
7635 CHAR
7636 matches character CHAR literally.
7637
7638 `not-newline'
7639 matches any character except a newline.
7640 .
7641 `anything'
7642 matches any character
7643
7644 `(any SET)'
7645 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
7646 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
7647
7648 '(in SET)'
7649 like `any'.
7650
7651 `(not (any SET))'
7652 matches any character not in SET
7653
7654 `line-start'
7655 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
7656 in the text being matched
7657
7658 `line-end'
7659 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
7660
7661 `string-start'
7662 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7663 string being matched against.
7664
7665 `string-end'
7666 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7667 string being matched against.
7668
7669 `buffer-start'
7670 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7671 buffer being matched against.
7672
7673 `buffer-end'
7674 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7675 buffer being matched against.
7676
7677 `point'
7678 matches the empty string, but only at point.
7679
7680 `word-start'
7681 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7682 word.
7683
7684 `word-end'
7685 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
7686
7687 `word-boundary'
7688 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7689 word.
7690
7691 `(not word-boundary)'
7692 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
7693 word.
7694
7695 `digit'
7696 matches 0 through 9.
7697
7698 `control'
7699 matches ASCII control characters.
7700
7701 `hex-digit'
7702 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7703
7704 `blank'
7705 matches space and tab only.
7706
7707 `graphic'
7708 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7709 space, and DEL.
7710
7711 `printing'
7712 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7713 and DEL.
7714
7715 `alphanumeric'
7716 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7717 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7718
7719 `letter'
7720 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7721 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7722
7723 `ascii'
7724 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7725
7726 `nonascii'
7727 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7728
7729 `lower'
7730 matches anything lower-case.
7731
7732 `upper'
7733 matches anything upper-case.
7734
7735 `punctuation'
7736 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7737 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7738
7739 `space'
7740 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7741
7742 `word'
7743 matches anything that has word syntax.
7744
7745 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
7746 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
7747 of the following symbols.
7748
7749 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
7750 `punctuation' (\\s.)
7751 `word' (\\sw)
7752 `symbol' (\\s_)
7753 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
7754 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
7755 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
7756 `string-quote' (\\s\")
7757 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
7758 `escape' (\\s\\)
7759 `character-quote' (\\s/)
7760 `comment-start' (\\s<)
7761 `comment-end' (\\s>)
7762
7763 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
7764 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
7765
7766 `(category CATEGORY)'
7767 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
7768 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
7769
7770 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
7771 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
7772 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
7773 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
7774 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
7775 `symbol' (\\c5)
7776 `digit' (\\c6)
7777 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
7778 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
7779 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
7780 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
7781 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
7782 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
7783 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
7784 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
7785 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
7786 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
7787 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
7788 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
7789 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
7790 `ascii' (\\ca)
7791 `arabic' (\\cb)
7792 `chinese' (\\cc)
7793 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
7794 `greek' (\\cg)
7795 `korean' (\\ch)
7796 `indian' (\\ci)
7797 `japanese' (\\cj)
7798 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
7799 `latin' (\\cl)
7800 `lao' (\\co)
7801 `tibetan' (\\cq)
7802 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
7803 `thai' (\\ct)
7804 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
7805 `hebrew' (\\cw)
7806 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
7807 `can-break' (\\c|)
7808
7809 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
7810 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
7811
7812 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7813 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
7814
7815 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7816 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
7817 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
7818
7819 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7820 another name for `submatch'.
7821
7822 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7823 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
7824 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
7825 regular expression.
7826
7827 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
7828 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
7829 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
7830 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
7831 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
7832
7833 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
7834 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
7835
7836 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
7837 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7838
7839 `(0+ SEXP)'
7840 like `zero-or-more'.
7841
7842 `(* SEXP)'
7843 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7844
7845 `(*? SEXP)'
7846 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7847
7848 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
7849 matches one or more occurrences of A.
7850
7851 `(1+ SEXP)'
7852 like `one-or-more'.
7853
7854 `(+ SEXP)'
7855 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7856
7857 `(+? SEXP)'
7858 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7859
7860 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
7861 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
7862
7863 `(optional SEXP)'
7864 like `zero-or-one'.
7865
7866 `(? SEXP)'
7867 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7868
7869 `(?? SEXP)'
7870 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7871
7872 `(repeat N SEXP)'
7873 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7874
7875 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
7876 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7877
7878 `(eval FORM)'
7879 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
7880 `regexp-quote' it.
7881
7882 `(regexp REGEXP)'
7883 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
7884
7885 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
7886
7887 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
7888 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
7889 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
7890 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
7891
7892 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
7893 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
7894 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
7895 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
7896
7897 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
7898 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
7899 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
7900
7901 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
7902 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
7903 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
7904 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
7905 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
7906 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
7907 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
7908 eight-bit-graphic.
7909
7910 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
7911
7912 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
7913 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
7914 character set as previously.
7915
7916 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
7917 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
7918 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
7919
7920 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
7921 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
7922 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
7923 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
7924
7925 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
7926 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
7927
7928 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
7929 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
7930 "fontset-default".
7931
7932 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
7933 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
7934
7935 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
7936 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
7937 buffers and strings.
7938
7939 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
7940 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
7941 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
7942 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
7943 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
7944 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
7945 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
7946 also been deleted.
7947
7948 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
7949 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
7950 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
7951
7952 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
7953 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
7954 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
7955 may differ between buffer and string text.
7956
7957 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
7958 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
7959
7960 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
7961 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
7962 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
7963 `composition' from STRING.
7964
7965 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
7966 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
7967
7968 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
7969 obsolete.
7970
7971 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
7972 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
7973
7974 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
7975 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
7976 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
7977 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
7978
7979 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
7980 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
7981 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
7982 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
7983 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
7984 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
7985
7986 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
7987 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
7988 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
7989
7990 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
7991 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
7992 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
7993
7994 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
7995 have been introduced.
7996
7997 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7998 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
7999 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
8000 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
8001 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
8002 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
8003 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
8004 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
8005 their multibyte equivalent.
8006
8007 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
8008 that offset in the file before writing.
8009
8010 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
8011 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
8012
8013 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
8014 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
8015 from which the command was issued.
8016
8017 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
8018 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
8019 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
8020 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
8021 operate on.
8022
8023 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
8024 to `window-buffer-height'.
8025
8026 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
8027
8028 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
8029 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
8030 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
8031
8032 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
8033 respectively.
8034
8035 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
8036 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
8037
8038 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
8039 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
8040 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
8041
8042 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
8043 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
8044 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
8045 is currently displayed in some window.
8046
8047 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
8048 argument function's results.
8049
8050 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
8051 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
8052 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
8053 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
8054 sequence).
8055
8056 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
8057 header in the list of headers passed to it.
8058
8059 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
8060 ignores differences in case and text representation.
8061
8062 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
8063 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
8064 as follows:
8065
8066 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
8067 nil don't display a cursor
8068 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
8069 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
8070 others display a box cursor.
8071
8072 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
8073 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
8074 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
8075 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
8076
8077 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
8078 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
8079 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
8080 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
8081
8082 Example:
8083
8084 (string-to-syntax "()")
8085 => (4 . 41)
8086
8087 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
8088 other than 10.
8089
8090 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
8091 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
8092
8093 #b1111
8094 => 15
8095 #b-1111
8096 => -15
8097
8098 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
8099
8100 #o666
8101 => 438
8102
8103 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
8104
8105 #xbeef
8106 => 48815
8107
8108 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
8109
8110 #2R-111
8111 => -7
8112 #25rah
8113 => 267
8114
8115 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
8116 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
8117 and isn't a string.
8118
8119 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
8120 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
8121 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
8122 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
8123
8124 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
8125
8126 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
8127 for a regexp in a string.
8128
8129 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
8130 `mouse-position-function'.
8131
8132 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
8133 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
8134
8135 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
8136 Keywords are now always considered constants.
8137
8138 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
8139 returns it.
8140
8141 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
8142 returned by function `recent-keys'.
8143
8144 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
8145 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
8146 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
8147 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
8148 mode.
8149
8150 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
8151 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
8152
8153 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
8154 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
8155 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
8156 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
8157 been performed."
8158
8159 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
8160 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
8161 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
8162 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
8163
8164 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
8165 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
8166 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
8167
8168 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
8169 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
8170 specified table.
8171
8172 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
8173
8174 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
8175 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
8176 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
8177 what BODY returns.
8178
8179 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
8180 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8181 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
8182 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
8183 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8184
8185 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
8186 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
8187
8188 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
8189 instead of being optional.
8190
8191 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
8192 modify read-only text.
8193
8194 ** New functions and variables for locales.
8195
8196 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
8197 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
8198 time functions like strftime. The new variables
8199 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
8200 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
8201
8202 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
8203 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
8204 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
8205 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
8206 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
8207 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
8208 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
8209
8210 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
8211 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
8212 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
8213 start sequences.
8214
8215 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
8216 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
8217
8218 ** New function `propertize'
8219
8220 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
8221 strings with text properties.
8222
8223 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
8224
8225 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
8226 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
8227 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
8228 specified value of that property. Example:
8229
8230 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
8231
8232 ** push and pop macros.
8233
8234 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
8235 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
8236 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
8237
8238 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
8239 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
8240 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
8241
8242 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
8243
8244 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
8245 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
8246
8247 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
8248 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
8249 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
8250 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8251
8252 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
8253 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8254 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8255 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8256
8257 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8258 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8259 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8260 or a sign.
8261
8262 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8263 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8264 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8265 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8266 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8267 space, and DEL.
8268 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8269 and DEL.
8270 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8271 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8272 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8273 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8274 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8275 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8276 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8277 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8278 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8279 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8280 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8281 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8282 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8283 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8284 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8285
8286 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8287
8288 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8289
8290 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8291
8292 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8293 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8294
8295 :test TEST
8296
8297 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8298 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8299 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8300
8301 :size SIZE
8302
8303 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8304 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8305
8306 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8307
8308 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8309 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8310 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8311 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8312 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8313
8314 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8315
8316 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8317 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8318 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8319
8320 :weakness WEAK
8321
8322 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8323 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8324 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8325 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8326 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8327
8328 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8329
8330 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8331
8332 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8333
8334 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8335
8336 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8337
8338 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8339 values are shared.
8340
8341 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8342
8343 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8344
8345 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8346
8347 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8348
8349 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8350
8351 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8352
8353 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8354
8355 Returns the size of TABLE.
8356
8357 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8358
8359 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8360
8361 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8362
8363 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8364
8365 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8366
8367 Clear TABLE.
8368
8369 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8370
8371 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8372 not found.
8373
8374 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8375
8376 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8377 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8378
8379 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8380
8381 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8382
8383 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8384
8385 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8386 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8387
8388 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8389
8390 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8391
8392 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8393
8394 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8395 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8396 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
8397 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8398 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8399
8400 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8401
8402 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8403 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8404 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8405
8406 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8407 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8408
8409 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8410 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8411
8412 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8413 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8414
8415 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
8416 'case-fold-string-hash))
8417
8418 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8419
8420 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8421
8422 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8423 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8424 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8425
8426 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8427
8428 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8429 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8430
8431 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8432 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8433 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8434 is too short to reach that column.
8435
8436 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8437 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8438 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8439 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8440
8441 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8442 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8443 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8444
8445 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8446 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8447
8448 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8449 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8450
8451 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8452 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8453 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8454 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8455 temporary-file-directory instead.
8456
8457 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8458 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8459 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8460 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8461
8462 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8463 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
8464
8465 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8466
8467 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8468 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8469 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8470
8471 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
8472
8473 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
8474 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
8475 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
8476 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
8477 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
8478 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
8479
8480 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
8481 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
8482 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
8483 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
8484
8485 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
8486
8487 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
8488 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
8489 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
8490 result string.
8491
8492 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
8493 string where arguments appear in the result string.
8494
8495 Example:
8496
8497 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8498 (s2 "world"))
8499 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8500 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8501 (format s1 s2))
8502
8503 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8504
8505 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8506
8507 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8508 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8509 argument in it.
8510
8511 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8512 (arg "world"))
8513 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8514 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8515 (message msg arg))
8516
8517 ** Sound support
8518
8519 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8520 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8521
8522 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
8523 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
8524 to enable sound support.
8525
8526 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
8527 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
8528 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
8529 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
8530 sound to play, before playing the sound.
8531
8532 The following sound properties are supported:
8533
8534 - `:file FILE'
8535
8536 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
8537 searched relative to `data-directory'.
8538
8539 - `:data DATA'
8540
8541 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
8542 may be present, but not both.
8543
8544 - `:volume VOLUME'
8545
8546 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
8547 0..1. This property is optional.
8548
8549 - `:device DEVICE'
8550
8551 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
8552 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
8553
8554 Other properties are ignored.
8555
8556 An alternative interface is called as
8557 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
8558
8559 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
8560
8561 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
8562 a keyword symbol.
8563
8564 ** Changes to garbage collection
8565
8566 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
8567 of live and free strings.
8568
8569 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
8570 strings that have been consed so far.
8571
8572 \f
8573 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
8574 Lisp Manual
8575
8576 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
8577 mini-windows.
8578
8579 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
8580 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
8581 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
8582
8583 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
8584
8585 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
8586
8587 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
8588 image.
8589
8590 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
8591
8592 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
8593
8594 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
8595 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
8596 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
8597 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
8598 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
8599
8600 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
8601 has a mask bitmap.
8602
8603 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
8604
8605 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
8606 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
8607 or omitted means use the selected frame.
8608
8609 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
8610 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
8611
8612 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
8613 optional.
8614
8615 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
8616 below).
8617
8618 \f
8619 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
8620
8621 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
8622 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
8623
8624 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
8625 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
8626 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
8627 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
8628 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
8629 just display it black instead.
8630
8631 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
8632 a line like
8633
8634 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
8635
8636 in your `.emacs'.
8637
8638 ** New face implementation.
8639
8640 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
8641 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
8642
8643 *** New faces.
8644
8645 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
8646
8647 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
8648
8649 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
8650 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
8651
8652 3. Font height in 1/10pt
8653
8654 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
8655
8656 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
8657
8658 6. Foreground color.
8659
8660 7. Background color.
8661
8662 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
8663
8664 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
8665
8666 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
8667
8668 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
8669
8670 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
8671 color.
8672
8673 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
8674 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
8675
8676 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
8677 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
8678 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
8679 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
8680 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
8681 attributes mentioned above.
8682
8683 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
8684 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
8685 created frames.
8686
8687 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
8688 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
8689 `fully-specified'.
8690
8691 *** Face merging.
8692
8693 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
8694 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
8695 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
8696 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
8697 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
8698 results in a fully-specified face.
8699
8700 *** Face realization.
8701
8702 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
8703 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
8704 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
8705 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
8706 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
8707 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
8708
8709 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
8710 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
8711 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
8712 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
8713
8714 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
8715 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
8716 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
8717 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
8718 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
8719
8720 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
8721 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
8722 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
8723 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
8724 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
8725 Emacs.
8726
8727 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
8728 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
8729 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
8730 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
8731
8732 **** Clearing face caches.
8733
8734 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
8735 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
8736 unused fonts.
8737
8738 *** Font selection.
8739
8740 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
8741 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
8742 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
8743
8744 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
8745 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
8746 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
8747 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
8748 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
8749
8750 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
8751 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
8752 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
8753
8754 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
8755
8756 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
8757 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
8758 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
8759 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
8760 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
8761 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
8762 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
8763
8764 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8765 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
8766 doesn't exist.
8767
8768 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8769 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
8770 registry.
8771
8772 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
8773 slightly different.
8774
8775 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
8776
8777
8778 **** Scalable fonts
8779
8780 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
8781 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
8782 servers.
8783
8784 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
8785 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
8786 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
8787 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
8788 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
8789 that list. Example:
8790
8791 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
8792
8793 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
8794
8795 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
8796
8797 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
8798
8799 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
8800 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
8801 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
8802
8803 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
8804 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
8805 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
8806 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
8807 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
8808 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
8809 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
8810 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
8811 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
8812 of the face font sort order.
8813
8814 - Function: x-font-family-list
8815
8816 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
8817 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
8818 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
8819 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
8820
8821 - Variable: font-list-limit
8822
8823 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
8824 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
8825 matching font. The default is currently 100.
8826
8827 *** Setting face attributes.
8828
8829 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
8830 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
8831 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
8832 `face-attribute'.
8833
8834 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
8835 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
8836
8837 The following attributes are recognized:
8838
8839 `:family'
8840
8841 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
8842 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
8843 and `?' are allowed.
8844
8845 `:width'
8846
8847 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
8848 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
8849 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
8850 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
8851
8852 `:height'
8853
8854 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
8855 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
8856 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
8857 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
8858
8859 `:weight'
8860
8861 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
8862 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
8863 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
8864
8865 `:slant'
8866
8867 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
8868 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
8869 `reverse-oblique'.
8870
8871 `:foreground', `:background'
8872
8873 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
8874
8875 `:underline'
8876
8877 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
8878 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
8879 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
8880 don't underline.
8881
8882 `:overline'
8883
8884 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
8885 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
8886 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
8887 overline.
8888
8889 `:strike-through'
8890
8891 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
8892 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
8893 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
8894 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
8895
8896 `:box'
8897
8898 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
8899 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
8900 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
8901 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
8902 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
8903 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
8904 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
8905 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
8906 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
8907 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
8908 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
8909 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
8910 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
8911 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
8912 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
8913 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
8914 box.
8915
8916 `:inverse-video'
8917
8918 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
8919 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
8920
8921 `:stipple'
8922
8923 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
8924 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
8925 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
8926 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
8927 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
8928 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
8929
8930 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
8931 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
8932
8933 `:font'
8934
8935 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
8936 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
8937 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
8938 versions of Emacs.
8939
8940 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
8941 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
8942 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
8943
8944 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
8945 `defface'.
8946
8947 `:inherit'
8948
8949 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
8950 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
8951 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
8952
8953 *** Face attributes and X resources
8954
8955 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
8956 from X resources:
8957
8958 Face attribute X resource class
8959 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
8960 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
8961 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
8962 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
8963 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
8964 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
8965 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
8966 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
8967 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
8968 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
8969 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
8970 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
8971 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
8972 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
8973 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
8974 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
8975 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8976 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
8977 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
8978 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8979
8980 *** Text property `face'.
8981
8982 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
8983 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
8984 specification can be
8985
8986 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
8987
8988 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
8989 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
8990 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
8991 for face attribute names.
8992
8993 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
8994 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
8995 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
8996
8997 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
8998
8999 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
9000 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
9001 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
9002 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
9003 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
9004 used to clear the mapping table.
9005
9006 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
9007
9008 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
9009 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
9010 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
9011 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
9012 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
9013 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
9014 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
9015 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
9016 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
9017 modify their color-related behavior.
9018
9019 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
9020 any frame type.
9021
9022 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
9023
9024 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
9025 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
9026 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
9027 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
9028 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
9029 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
9030 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
9031 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
9032 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
9033
9034 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
9035 display can display image files.
9036
9037 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
9038
9039 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
9040 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
9041 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
9042 `Inviolable' option.
9043
9044 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
9045 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
9046 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
9047
9048 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
9049
9050 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
9051 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
9052 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
9053
9054 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
9055 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9056 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
9057 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
9058 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
9059 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
9060 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
9061 functions.
9062
9063 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9064 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
9065 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
9066
9067 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
9068
9069 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9070
9071 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
9072
9073 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9074 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9075 constrained position if that is different.
9076
9077 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
9078 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
9079 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
9080 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9081 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9082 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
9083 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
9084 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
9085 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9086
9087 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
9088 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
9089 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
9090 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
9091 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
9092
9093 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
9094 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
9095
9096 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
9097
9098 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
9099
9100 Delete the field surrounding POS.
9101 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9102 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9103
9104 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9105
9106 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
9107 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9108 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9109 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9110 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
9111
9112 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9113
9114 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
9115 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9116 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9117 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9118 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
9119
9120 - Function: field-string &optional POS
9121
9122 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
9123 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9124 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9125
9126 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
9127
9128 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
9129 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9130 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9131
9132 ** Image support.
9133
9134 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
9135 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
9136 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
9137 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
9138
9139 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
9140 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
9141 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
9142 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
9143 area.
9144
9145 IMAGE is an image specification.
9146
9147 *** Image specifications
9148
9149 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
9150 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
9151 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
9152 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
9153 described below are ignored.
9154
9155 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
9156
9157 `:ascent ASCENT'
9158
9159 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
9160 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
9161 to use for its ascent.
9162
9163 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
9164 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
9165
9166 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
9167 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
9168 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
9169 overlays that apply to the image.
9170
9171 `:margin MARGIN'
9172
9173 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
9174 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
9175 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
9176
9177 `:relief RELIEF'
9178
9179 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
9180 around an image.
9181
9182 `:conversion ALGO'
9183
9184 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
9185
9186 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
9187 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
9188
9189 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
9190 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
9191 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
9192 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
9193 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
9194 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
9195 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
9196 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
9197 below.
9198
9199 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
9200 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
9201 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
9202
9203 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
9204 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
9205 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
9206 of the factors' absolute values.
9207
9208 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
9209
9210 (1 0 0
9211 0 0 0
9212 9 9 -1)
9213
9214 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
9215
9216 ( 2 -1 0
9217 -1 0 1
9218 0 1 -2)
9219
9220 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
9221 ``disabled''.
9222
9223 `:mask MASK'
9224
9225 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
9226 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
9227 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
9228 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
9229 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
9230 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
9231 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
9232 image.
9233
9234 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
9235 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
9236 `:mask nil'.
9237
9238 `:file FILE'
9239
9240 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
9241 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
9242 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
9243 may be present in the image specification.
9244
9245 `:data DATA'
9246
9247 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
9248 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
9249 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
9250 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
9251
9252 *** Supported image types
9253
9254 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9255
9256 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9257 properties supported are:
9258
9259 `:foreground FG'
9260
9261 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9262 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9263
9264 `:background BG'
9265
9266 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9267 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9268
9269 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9270 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9271 instead of a `:file' property.
9272
9273 `:width WIDTH'
9274
9275 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9276
9277 `:height HEIGHT'
9278
9279 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9280
9281 `:data DATA'
9282
9283 DATA must be either
9284
9285 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9286 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9287
9288 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9289
9290 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9291 bitmap.
9292
9293 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9294 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9295 in the file.
9296
9297 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9298
9299 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9300 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9301 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9302 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9303
9304 Additional image properties supported are:
9305
9306 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9307
9308 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9309 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9310 name.
9311
9312 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9313 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9314
9315 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9316 to display compressed images.
9317
9318 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9319
9320 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9321 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9322 mono images are:
9323
9324 `:foreground FG'
9325
9326 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9327 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9328
9329 `:background FG'
9330
9331 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9332 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9333
9334 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9335
9336 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9337 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9338 properties defined.
9339
9340 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9341
9342 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9343 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9344 properties defined.
9345
9346 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9347
9348 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9349 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9350
9351 Additional image properties supported are:
9352
9353 `:index INDEX'
9354
9355 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9356 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9357 as a hollow box.
9358
9359 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9360 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9361 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9362 every 0.1 seconds.
9363
9364 (defun show-anim (file max)
9365 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9366 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9367
9368 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9369 (when (= idx max)
9370 (setq idx 0))
9371 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9372 (save-excursion
9373 (set-buffer buffer)
9374 (goto-char (point-min))
9375 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9376 (insert-image img "x"))
9377 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9378
9379 **** PNG, image type `png'
9380
9381 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9382 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9383 properties defined.
9384
9385 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9386
9387 Additional image properties supported are:
9388
9389 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9390
9391 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9392 integer. This is a required property.
9393
9394 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9395
9396 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
9397 must be a integer. This is an required property.
9398
9399 `:bounding-box BOX'
9400
9401 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9402 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9403 files. This is an required property.
9404
9405 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9406 lisp/gs.el.
9407
9408 *** Lisp interface.
9409
9410 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9411 which are supported in the current configuration.
9412
9413 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9414 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9415 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
9416 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9417 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
9418
9419 *** Simplified image API, image.el
9420
9421 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9422 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9423 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9424 define an image based on available image types. The functions
9425 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9426 buffer.
9427
9428 ** Display margins.
9429
9430 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9431 and images.
9432
9433 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9434 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9435 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9436 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9437 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9438 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9439 of the display margins.
9440
9441 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9442 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9443 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9444 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9445 in this file).
9446
9447 ** Help display
9448
9449 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9450 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9451 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9452 that have a `help-echo' property.
9453
9454 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
9455 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
9456 the window in which the help was found.
9457
9458 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9459 `help-echo' text property was found.
9460
9461 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9462 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9463
9464 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
9465 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
9466 mouse.
9467
9468 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9469 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9470
9471 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
9472 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
9473 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
9474 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
9475 used as help string.
9476
9477 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
9478 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
9479 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
9480
9481 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
9482
9483 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
9484 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
9485
9486 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
9487 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
9488 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
9489 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
9490 used.
9491
9492 (global-set-key [A-down]
9493 #'(lambda ()
9494 (interactive)
9495 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9496 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
9497 (global-set-key [A-up]
9498 #'(lambda ()
9499 (interactive)
9500 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9501 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9502
9503 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9504
9505 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9506 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9507 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9508 is called with one argument, POS.
9509
9510 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9511 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9512 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9513 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9514 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9515
9516 ** Tool bar support.
9517
9518 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9519 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9520 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9521 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9522 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
9523 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
9524
9525 *** Tool bar item definitions
9526
9527 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
9528 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
9529 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
9530
9531 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
9532 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
9533 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
9534 property (see below).
9535
9536 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
9537 binding are currently ignored.
9538
9539 The following properties are recognized:
9540
9541 `:enable FORM'.
9542
9543 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
9544 or disabled.
9545
9546 `:visible FORM'
9547
9548 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
9549
9550 `:filter FUNCTION'
9551
9552 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
9553 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
9554 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
9555
9556 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
9557
9558 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
9559 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
9560
9561 `:image IMAGES'
9562
9563 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
9564 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
9565 meaning of each of the four elements:
9566
9567 Index Use when item is
9568 ----------------------------------------
9569 0 enabled and selected
9570 1 enabled and deselected
9571 2 disabled and selected
9572 3 disabled and deselected
9573
9574 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
9575 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
9576
9577 `:help HELP-STRING'.
9578
9579 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
9580 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
9581
9582 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
9583 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
9584 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
9585 menu bar.
9586
9587 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
9588 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
9589 buffer-locally to override the global map.
9590
9591 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
9592
9593 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
9594 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
9595 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
9596
9597 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
9598 raised when the mouse moves over them.
9599
9600 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
9601 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
9602 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
9603 vertical margins . Default is 1.
9604
9605 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
9606 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
9607
9608 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
9609
9610 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
9611 a tool bar item. If
9612
9613 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
9614 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
9615 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
9616
9617 is the original tool bar item definition, then
9618
9619 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
9620
9621 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
9622 item.
9623
9624 ** Mode line changes.
9625
9626 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
9627
9628 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
9629 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
9630 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
9631
9632 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
9633 a `local-map' text property.
9634
9635 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
9636 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
9637
9638 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
9639 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
9640 `local-map' property.
9641
9642 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
9643 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
9644 example.
9645
9646 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
9647 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
9648
9649 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
9650 variable mode-line-format to nil.
9651
9652 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
9653
9654 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
9655 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
9656 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
9657 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
9658 line.
9659
9660 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
9661 `header-line'.
9662
9663 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
9664 position in the header-line.
9665
9666 ** Text property `display'
9667
9668 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
9669 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
9670 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
9671 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
9672 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
9673
9674 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
9675
9676 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
9677 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
9678
9679 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
9680 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
9681 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
9682 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9683 simpler form STRING as property value.
9684
9685 *** Variable width and height spaces
9686
9687 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
9688 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
9689 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
9690 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
9691 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
9692 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9693 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
9694
9695 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
9696 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
9697 properties described below.
9698
9699 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
9700 characters having the `display' property.
9701
9702 - :width WIDTH
9703
9704 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
9705 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
9706
9707 - :relative-width FACTOR
9708
9709 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
9710 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
9711 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
9712 width of that character by FACTOR.
9713
9714 - :align-to HPOS
9715
9716 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
9717 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
9718
9719 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
9720
9721 - :height HEIGHT
9722
9723 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
9724 normal line height.
9725
9726 - :relative-height FACTOR
9727
9728 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
9729 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
9730
9731 - :ascent ASCENT
9732
9733 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
9734 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
9735 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
9736 equal to 100.
9737
9738 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
9739
9740 *** Images
9741
9742 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
9743 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
9744 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
9745 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
9746 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
9747 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
9748 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
9749 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
9750 as display specification.
9751
9752 *** Other display properties
9753
9754 - (space-width FACTOR)
9755
9756 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
9757 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
9758 integer or float.
9759
9760 - (height HEIGHT)
9761
9762 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
9763
9764 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
9765 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
9766 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
9767 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
9768 a font is available counts as a step.
9769
9770 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
9771 as tall as the frame's default font.
9772
9773 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
9774 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
9775
9776 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
9777 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
9778
9779 - (raise FACTOR)
9780
9781 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
9782 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
9783 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
9784 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
9785 `height' subproperty.
9786
9787 *** Conditional display properties
9788
9789 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
9790 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
9791 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
9792 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
9793 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
9794 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
9795 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
9796 different when object is a string.
9797
9798 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
9799 `(when t . SPEC)'.
9800
9801 ** New menu separator types.
9802
9803 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
9804 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
9805 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
9806 to specify other menu separator types.
9807
9808 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
9809
9810 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
9811 separator occurs.
9812
9813 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
9814
9815 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
9816
9817 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
9818
9819 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
9820
9821 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
9822
9823 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9824
9825 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
9826
9827 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9828
9829 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
9830
9831 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
9832 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
9833
9834 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
9835
9836 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
9837
9838 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
9839
9840 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
9841
9842 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
9843
9844 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
9845
9846 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
9847
9848 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9849
9850 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
9851
9852 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
9853
9854 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
9855
9856 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9857
9858 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
9859
9860 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
9861
9862 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
9863 the corresponding single-line separators.
9864
9865 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
9866
9867 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
9868 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
9869 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
9870 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
9871 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
9872 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
9873 default foreground is black.
9874
9875 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
9876 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
9877 `ScrollBarBackground').
9878
9879 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
9880 settings for scroll bar colors.
9881
9882 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
9883 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
9884
9885 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
9886 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
9887 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
9888 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
9889 the original window start.
9890
9891 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
9892 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
9893 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
9894
9895 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
9896
9897 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
9898 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
9899 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
9900 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
9901
9902 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
9903 fixed-width and fixed-height.
9904
9905 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
9906
9907 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
9908 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
9909 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
9910 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
9911 temporarily to nil, for example
9912
9913 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
9914 (enlarge-window 10))
9915
9916 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
9917 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
9918
9919 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
9920 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
9921 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
9922 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
9923 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
9924 support a vertical-bar cursor).
9925
9926
9927 \f
9928 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
9929
9930 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
9931 input.
9932
9933 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
9934
9935 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
9936
9937 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
9938 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
9939 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
9940 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
9941 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
9942
9943 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
9944 been added.
9945
9946 \f
9947 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
9948
9949 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
9950
9951
9952 \f
9953 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
9954
9955 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
9956 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
9957 \f
9958 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
9959
9960 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
9961
9962 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
9963 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
9964 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
9965
9966 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
9967 is the one that is used.
9968
9969 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
9970 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
9971 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
9972 separate from the command's regular output.
9973 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
9974 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
9975 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
9976 the buffer name.
9977
9978 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
9979 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
9980 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
9981 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
9982
9983 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
9984 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
9985 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
9986 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
9987
9988 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
9989 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
9990 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
9991 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
9992
9993 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
9994 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
9995 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
9996 they never ignore case.
9997
9998 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
9999 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
10000 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
10001 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
10002 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
10003 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
10004 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
10005
10006 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
10007 the same format that was used in the file before.
10008
10009 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
10010 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
10011
10012 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
10013 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
10014 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
10015
10016 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
10017 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
10018 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
10019 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
10020 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
10021 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
10022 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
10023
10024 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
10025 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
10026 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
10027 format. You can now customize these variables.
10028
10029 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
10030 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
10031 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
10032 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
10033
10034 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
10035 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
10036 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
10037
10038 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
10039 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
10040 doesn't have any effect.
10041
10042 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
10043 not one per buffer.
10044
10045 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
10046 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
10047 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
10048
10049 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
10050 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
10051 `auto-show-mode' command.
10052
10053 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
10054 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
10055 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
10056 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
10057 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
10058
10059 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
10060 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
10061
10062 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
10063 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
10064 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
10065
10066 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
10067 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
10068 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
10069 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
10070
10071 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
10072
10073 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
10074 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
10075 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
10076 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
10077 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
10078
10079 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
10080 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
10081
10082 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
10083 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
10084 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
10085 `?' on other systems.
10086
10087 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
10088 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
10089 Unix.
10090
10091 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
10092 current codepage when it starts.
10093
10094 ** Mail changes
10095
10096 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
10097 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
10098 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
10099 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
10100 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
10101 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
10102 latin-1:
10103
10104 MIME-version: 1.0
10105 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
10106 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
10107
10108 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
10109 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
10110 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
10111 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
10112 buffer-file-coding-system.
10113
10114 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
10115 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
10116 mail.
10117
10118 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
10119 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
10120 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
10121 list of possible coding systems.
10122
10123 ** CC Mode changes
10124
10125 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
10126 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
10127 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
10128 docstring for details.
10129
10130 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
10131 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
10132 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
10133 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
10134 lineup functions use this feature currently.
10135
10136 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
10137 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
10138
10139 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
10140 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
10141
10142 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
10143 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
10144 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
10145 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
10146 anonymous classes.
10147
10148 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
10149 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
10150
10151 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
10152 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
10153 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
10154 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
10155
10156 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
10157 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
10158 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
10159 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
10160 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
10161
10162 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
10163
10164 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
10165
10166 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
10167 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
10168
10169 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
10170
10171 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
10172 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
10173 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
10174 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
10175 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
10176
10177 ** Gnus changes.
10178
10179 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
10180 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
10181 Gnus manual for the full story.
10182
10183 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
10184 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
10185 group, which is created automatically.
10186
10187 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
10188 values.
10189
10190 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
10191
10192 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
10193 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
10194
10195 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
10196 `C-u C-c C-c'.
10197
10198 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
10199
10200 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
10201 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
10202
10203 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
10204
10205 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
10206 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
10207
10208 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
10209 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
10210
10211 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
10212 control over simplification.
10213
10214 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
10215
10216 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
10217 limit.
10218
10219 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
10220
10221 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
10222
10223 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
10224 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
10225 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
10226
10227 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
10228 `a' forces normal posting method.
10229
10230 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
10231 -- `W d'.
10232
10233 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
10234 to a non-nil value.
10235
10236 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
10237 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
10238
10239 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
10240 has been added.
10241
10242 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
10243
10244 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
10245
10246 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
10247 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
10248
10249 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
10250 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
10251
10252 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
10253
10254 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10255 been added.
10256
10257 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10258 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10259
10260 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10261 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10262
10263 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10264
10265 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10266
10267 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10268
10269 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10270
10271 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10272 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10273 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10274
10275 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10276 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10277 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10278 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10279 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10280
10281 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10282 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10283 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10284 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10285
10286 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10287 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10288 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10289 mismatch.
10290
10291 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10292
10293 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10294 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10295
10296 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10297 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10298 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10299 removed from the label.
10300
10301 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10302 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10303
10304 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10305 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10306
10307 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10308 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10309 expressions.
10310
10311 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10312
10313 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10314
10315 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10316 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10317
10318 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10319 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10320 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10321
10322 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
10323 changes with a special face.
10324
10325 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10326 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10327 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10328 \f
10329 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10330
10331 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10332 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10333 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10334 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10335 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10336
10337 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10338 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10339 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10340
10341 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10342 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10343 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10344 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10345 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10346 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10347 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10348 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10349 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10350
10351 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10352 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10353 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10354 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10355 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10356 program.
10357
10358 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10359 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10360 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10361 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10362 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10363 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10364
10365 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10366 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10367 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10368 was not documented clearly before.
10369
10370 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10371 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10372 \f
10373 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10374
10375 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10376 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10377 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10378 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10379
10380 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10381 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10382 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10383
10384 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10385
10386 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10387 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10388
10389 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10390 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10391 integers.
10392
10393 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10394 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10395 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10396 file names and attributes are returned.
10397
10398 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10399 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
10400 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
10401 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10402 returns the result.
10403
10404 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10405 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10406
10407 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
10408
10409 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10410 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10411 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10412 optionally.
10413
10414 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10415 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10416
10417 **
10418 The new function process-running-child-p
10419 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10420 terminal to its own child process.
10421
10422 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10423 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10424 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10425 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10426
10427 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10428 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10429
10430 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
10431 :included is an alias for :visible.
10432
10433 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10434 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10435 to move or copy menu entries.
10436
10437 ** Multibyte editing changes
10438
10439 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10440 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10441 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10442 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10443 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10444 (setq char (sref str idx)
10445 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10446 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10447
10448 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10449 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10450 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10451
10452 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10453 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10454 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10455
10456 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
10457
10458 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10459 across the boundary.
10460
10461 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10462 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10463 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10464 contains 8-bit characters.
10465 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10466 contains invalid characters.
10467
10468 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10469 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10470 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10471 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10472 way.
10473
10474 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
10475 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
10476 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
10477 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
10478
10479 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
10480 compose Thai characters in a string.
10481
10482 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
10483 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
10484 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
10485 menus should always use the third argument.
10486
10487 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
10488 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
10489 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
10490 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
10491
10492 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
10493 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10494 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10495 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10496
10497 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10498 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10499 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10500 echo area contents.
10501
10502 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10503
10504 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10505 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10506 requested feature cannot be loaded.
10507
10508 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10509 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10510 means to clear out that attribute.
10511
10512 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10513 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10514
10515 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10516 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10517 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10518 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10519
10520 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10521 the gap of the current buffer.
10522
10523 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10524 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10525 current buffer.
10526
10527 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
10528 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
10529 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
10530 it back in after any modifications have been made.
10531 \f
10532 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
10533
10534 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
10535 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
10536 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
10537 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
10538 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
10539
10540 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
10541 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
10542 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
10543 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
10544 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
10545
10546 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
10547 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
10548 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
10549
10550 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
10551 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
10552 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
10553 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
10554 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
10555 results.
10556
10557 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
10558 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
10559 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
10560 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
10561 \f
10562 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
10563
10564 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
10565 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
10566 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
10567 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
10568
10569 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
10570 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
10571 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
10572 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
10573 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
10574 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
10575 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
10576 region.
10577
10578 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
10579 selective undo.
10580
10581 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
10582 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
10583 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
10584 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
10585 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
10586
10587 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
10588 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
10589 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
10590 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
10591
10592 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
10593 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
10594 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
10595 something that most users not do.
10596
10597 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
10598 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
10599 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
10600 applications.
10601
10602 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
10603 pasting operations.
10604
10605 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
10606 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
10607 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
10608 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
10609 `ps-printer-name'.
10610
10611 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
10612 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
10613 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
10614 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
10615 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
10616 hits a new word.
10617
10618 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
10619 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
10620 to be confused by TeX commands.
10621
10622 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
10623 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
10624 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
10625 of various alternative replacements and actions.
10626
10627 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
10628 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
10629 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
10630 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
10631 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
10632
10633 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
10634 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
10635
10636 ** Changes in input method usage.
10637
10638 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
10639 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
10640 respectively.
10641
10642 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
10643
10644 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
10645 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
10646
10647 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
10648 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
10649
10650 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
10651
10652 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
10653
10654 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
10655 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
10656
10657 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
10658 given in the following case:
10659 o When you are using a complex input method.
10660 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
10661
10662 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
10663 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
10664 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
10665 setting it to t is helpful.
10666
10667 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
10668
10669 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
10670 keys:
10671 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
10672 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
10673 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
10674 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
10675 environment.
10676
10677 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
10678 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
10679 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
10680 get
10681
10682 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
10683
10684 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
10685
10686 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
10687 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
10688
10689 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
10690 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
10691 its owner and group.
10692
10693 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
10694 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
10695
10696 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
10697 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
10698
10699 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
10700 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
10701 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
10702 by the left edge of the rectangle.
10703
10704 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
10705 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
10706 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
10707 for writing keyboard macros.
10708
10709 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
10710 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
10711 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
10712 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
10713 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
10714 info.
10715
10716 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
10717
10718 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
10719 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
10720 contents only.
10721
10722 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
10723 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
10724 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
10725 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
10726
10727 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
10728 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
10729 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
10730
10731 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
10732 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
10733 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
10734 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
10735
10736 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
10737 failure if the command produces no output.
10738
10739 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
10740 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
10741 the mouse.
10742
10743 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
10744 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
10745 function and variable names.
10746
10747 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
10748 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
10749 file-coding-system-alist.
10750
10751 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
10752 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
10753 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
10754 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
10755 according to the current fontset.
10756
10757 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
10758
10759 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
10760 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
10761 nonascii-insert-offset.
10762
10763 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
10764 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
10765 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
10766 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
10767
10768 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
10769 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
10770
10771 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
10772 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
10773
10774 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
10775 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
10776 command keys.
10777
10778 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
10779 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
10780
10781 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
10782 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
10783 all variables that have documentation.
10784
10785 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
10786 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
10787 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
10788 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
10789 it should show; the default is 20.
10790
10791 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
10792 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
10793 of your input.
10794
10795 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
10796 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
10797 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
10798 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
10799 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
10800 Newly added options are included as well.
10801
10802 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
10803 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
10804 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
10805
10806 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
10807 Customize menu.
10808
10809 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
10810 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
10811
10812 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
10813 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
10814 invoked.
10815
10816 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
10817 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
10818 The default is 1.
10819
10820 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
10821 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
10822 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
10823 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
10824 sensibly.
10825
10826 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
10827
10828 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
10829 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
10830 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
10831
10832 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
10833 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
10834 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
10835 every night.
10836
10837 ** Desktop changes
10838
10839 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
10840 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
10841
10842 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
10843 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
10844
10845 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
10846 read and post multi-lingual articles.
10847
10848 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
10849 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
10850 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
10851 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
10852 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
10853 made invisible again.
10854
10855 ** Mail reading and sending changes
10856
10857 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
10858 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
10859 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
10860 toggle.
10861
10862 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
10863 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
10864 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
10865 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
10866 rmail-default-body-file.
10867
10868 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
10869 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
10870 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
10871
10872 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
10873 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
10874 is evaluated to insert the signature.
10875
10876 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
10877 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
10878 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
10879 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
10880 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
10881 especially interested in trying feedmail.
10882
10883 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
10884 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
10885 provided by feedmail are:
10886
10887 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
10888 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
10889 there is also a queue for draft messages
10890
10891 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
10892 be prompted for confirmation
10893
10894 **** does smart filling of address headers
10895
10896 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
10897 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
10898 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
10899
10900 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
10901 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
10902 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
10903 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code).
10904
10905 ** Dired changes
10906
10907 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
10908 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
10909
10910 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
10911 run Dired on the directory name at point.
10912
10913 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
10914 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
10915 for a specified regexp.
10916
10917 ** VC Changes
10918
10919 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
10920 conveniently.
10921
10922 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
10923 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
10924 Dired.
10925
10926 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
10927 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
10928 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
10929 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
10930
10931 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
10932 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
10933 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
10934 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
10935 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
10936
10937 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
10938 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
10939 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
10940 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
10941 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
10942
10943 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
10944 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
10945 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
10946 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
10947
10948 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
10949 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
10950 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
10951
10952 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
10953 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
10954 session to resolve them.
10955
10956 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
10957 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
10958 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
10959 uses as well).
10960
10961 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
10962 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
10963 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
10964 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
10965 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
10966 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
10967 using ediff.
10968
10969 ** Changes in Font Lock
10970
10971 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
10972 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
10973 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
10974 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
10975 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
10976
10977 ** Frame name display changes
10978
10979 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
10980 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
10981 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
10982 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
10983
10984 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
10985 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
10986 menu.
10987
10988 ** Comint (subshell) changes
10989
10990 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
10991 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
10992 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
10993
10994 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
10995
10996 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
10997 that is, the line after the last line you got.
10998 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
10999
11000 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
11001 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
11002 the following line.
11003
11004 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
11005 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
11006 previously sent input.
11007
11008 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
11009 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
11010 as the search string.
11011
11012 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
11013 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
11014
11015 ** C mode changes
11016
11017 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
11018 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
11019 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
11020 definition.
11021
11022 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
11023 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
11024 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
11025 style is still the default however.
11026
11027 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
11028
11029 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
11030 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
11031 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
11032
11033 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
11034 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
11035
11036 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
11037 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
11038
11039 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
11040 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
11041
11042 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
11043 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
11044
11045 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
11046 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
11047 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
11048 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
11049
11050 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
11051
11052 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
11053 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
11054 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
11055
11056 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
11057 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
11058 expanding dynamically.
11059
11060 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
11061 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
11062
11063 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
11064 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
11065 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
11066 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
11067
11068 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
11069
11070 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
11071
11072 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
11073 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
11074 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
11075 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
11076 against the first word in the title.
11077
11078 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
11079 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
11080 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
11081 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
11082 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
11083 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
11084
11085 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
11086 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
11087 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
11088 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
11089
11090 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
11091
11092 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
11093 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
11094 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
11095 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
11096 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
11097 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
11098
11099 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
11100 Editing group once the package is loaded.
11101
11102 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
11103 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
11104 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
11105
11106 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
11107 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
11108
11109 ** Ispell changes.
11110
11111 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
11112 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
11113 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
11114
11115 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
11116 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
11117 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
11118 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
11119 include:
11120
11121 o URLs are automatically skipped
11122 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
11123
11124 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
11125
11126 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
11127
11128 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
11129 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
11130 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
11131 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
11132
11133 *** New recursive parser.
11134
11135 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
11136 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
11137 recursive parser scans the individual files.
11138
11139 *** Parsing only part of a document.
11140
11141 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
11142 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
11143 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
11144
11145 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
11146
11147 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
11148
11149 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
11150
11151 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
11152
11153 *** Using multiple selection buffers
11154
11155 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
11156 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
11157
11158 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
11159
11160 *** References to external documents.
11161
11162 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
11163 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
11164 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
11165 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
11166 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
11167 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
11168 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
11169
11170 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
11171
11172 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
11173 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
11174
11175 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
11176 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
11177
11178 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
11179
11180 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
11181 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
11182
11183 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
11184
11185 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
11186 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
11187 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
11188 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
11189 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
11190 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
11191 more.
11192
11193 *** Support for the varioref package
11194
11195 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
11196
11197 *** New hooks
11198
11199 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
11200 and citations are created. These hooks are
11201 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
11202 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
11203
11204 *** Citations outside LaTeX
11205
11206 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
11207 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
11208
11209 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
11210
11211 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
11212 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
11213 fontified, use
11214
11215 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
11216
11217 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
11218 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
11219 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
11220 directories that contain the same file name.
11221
11222 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
11223 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
11224 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
11225 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
11226 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
11227 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
11228 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
11229 directory.
11230
11231 ** New modes and packages
11232
11233 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
11234 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
11235 it, but some do not.
11236
11237 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
11238 code.
11239
11240 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
11241 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
11242 around in a buffer.
11243
11244 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
11245
11246 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
11247 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
11248 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
11249 established system of notation similar to Chess.
11250
11251 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
11252 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
11253 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11254
11255 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11256 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11257 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
11258 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11259 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11260 the like.
11261
11262 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11263 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11264
11265 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11266 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11267 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11268 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11269
11270 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11271
11272 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11273 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11274 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11275 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11276 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
11277 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11278 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11279 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11280 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11281 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11282 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11283
11284 Platform-specific modes:
11285
11286 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11287 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11288 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11289 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11290 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11291 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11292 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11293 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11294 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11295 \f
11296 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11297
11298 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11299 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11300 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11301 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11302
11303 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11304 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11305 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11306
11307 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11308 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11309 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11310 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11311
11312 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11313 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11314 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11315 environment.
11316
11317 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11318 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11319 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11320 current input method for reading this one event.
11321
11322 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11323 now control whether to output certain characters as
11324 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11325 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11326 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11327 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11328 \f
11329 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11330
11331 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11332 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11333
11334 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11335 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11336 always increases point by 1.
11337
11338 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11339 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11340
11341 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11342
11343 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11344 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11345 default value changed. For example,
11346
11347 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11348 :type 'integer
11349 :group 'foo
11350 :version "20.3")
11351
11352 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11353 :version "20.3")
11354
11355 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11356 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11357 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11358 `:version' in the top level group.
11359
11360 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11361
11362 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11363 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11364
11365 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11366 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11367 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11368 to themselves.
11369
11370 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11371 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11372 values whatever.
11373
11374 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11375 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11376 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11377
11378 ** Frame-local variables.
11379
11380 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11381 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11382 local bindings for that variable.
11383
11384 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11385 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11386 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11387 parameter name.
11388
11389 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11390 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11391 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11392 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11393
11394 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11395 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11396 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11397 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11398
11399 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11400 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11401 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11402 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11403 See the documentation in sregex.el.
11404
11405 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11406 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11407 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11408 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11409
11410 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11411 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11412
11413 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11414 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11415 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11416
11417 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11418 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11419 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11420 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11421
11422 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11423 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11424 empty input.
11425
11426 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11427 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11428 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11429 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11430 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11431
11432 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11433 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11434 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11435 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11436
11437 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11438 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11439 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11440 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11441 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11442
11443 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11444 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11445 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11446 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11447
11448 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11449 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11450 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11451
11452 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11453 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11454 was directed to display this buffer.
11455
11456 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11457 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11458 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11459 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11460 set-window-configuration.
11461
11462 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11463 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11464 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11465 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11466
11467 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11468 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11469 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11470
11471 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11472 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11473 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11474
11475 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
11476 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
11477
11478 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
11479 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
11480
11481 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
11482 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
11483 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
11484
11485 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
11486 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
11487 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
11488 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
11489
11490 ** Menu changes
11491
11492 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
11493 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11494 better supported.
11495
11496 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11497 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11498 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11499 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11500 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11501
11502 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11503
11504 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11505 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11506 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11507 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11508
11509 The format is:
11510 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11511 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11512 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11513 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11514 The supported properties include
11515
11516 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11517 item is enabled.
11518 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11519 item should appear in the menu.
11520 :filter FILTER-FN
11521 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11522 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11523 It should return a binding to use instead.
11524 :keys DESCRIPTION
11525 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
11526 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
11527 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
11528 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
11529 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
11530 keyboard binding.
11531 :key-sequence nil
11532 This means that the command normally has no
11533 keyboard equivalent.
11534 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
11535 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
11536 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
11537 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
11538 value says whether this button is currently selected.
11539
11540 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
11541 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
11542
11543 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
11544
11545 ** New event types
11546
11547 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
11548 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
11549 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
11550 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
11551
11552 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
11553
11554 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11555 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
11556 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
11557 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
11558 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
11559 forward, away from the user.
11560
11561 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11562
11563 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
11564 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
11565 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
11566 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
11567 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
11568
11569 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
11570
11571 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11572 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
11573 that were dragged and dropped.
11574
11575 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11576
11577 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
11578
11579 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
11580 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
11581 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
11582
11583 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
11584 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
11585 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
11586
11587 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
11588 in Emacs 19 and before.
11589
11590 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
11591 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
11592
11593 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
11594 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
11595 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
11596 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
11597
11598 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
11599 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
11600 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
11601 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
11602 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
11603
11604 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
11605 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
11606 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
11607 consistent with the new representation.
11608
11609 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
11610 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
11611 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
11612 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11613
11614 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
11615 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
11616 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
11617
11618 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
11619 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
11620 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11621
11622 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
11623 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
11624 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
11625
11626 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11627 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
11628
11629 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11630 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
11631
11632 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
11633 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
11634 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
11635 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
11636
11637 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
11638 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
11639
11640 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
11641 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
11642 buffer or string being searched.
11643
11644 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
11645 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
11646 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
11647 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
11648 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
11649 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
11650 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
11651
11652 *** Structure of coding system changed.
11653
11654 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
11655 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
11656 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
11657 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
11658 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
11659 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
11660 define-coding-system-alias.
11661
11662 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
11663 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
11664 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
11665 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
11666 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
11667 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
11668 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
11669 `iso-8859-1'.
11670
11671 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
11672 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
11673 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
11674 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
11675
11676 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
11677 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
11678 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
11679 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
11680
11681 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
11682 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
11683 This function requires a user interaction.
11684
11685 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
11686 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
11687 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
11688 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
11689 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
11690 select-safe-coding-system.
11691
11692 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
11693 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
11694 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
11695 was done.
11696
11697 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
11698 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
11699 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
11700
11701 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
11702 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
11703 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
11704 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
11705
11706 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
11707 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
11708 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
11709 converted.
11710
11711 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
11712 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
11713
11714 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
11715 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
11716 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
11717 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
11718 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
11719 range of characters.
11720
11721 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
11722 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
11723
11724 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
11725 in the current buffer at position POS.
11726
11727 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
11728 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
11729 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
11730 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
11731 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
11732 binding input-method-function to nil.
11733
11734 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
11735 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
11736 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
11737 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
11738 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
11739
11740 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
11741 subsequent events of a key sequence.
11742
11743 *** You can customize any language environment by using
11744 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
11745
11746 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
11747 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
11748 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
11749 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
11750 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
11751 \f
11752 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
11753
11754 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
11755 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
11756 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
11757 tree structure.
11758
11759 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
11760 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
11761
11762 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
11763 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
11764 in your .emacs file.)
11765
11766 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
11767 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
11768
11769 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
11770 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
11771
11772 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
11773 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
11774 kills the region.
11775
11776 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
11777 delete the character before point, as usual.
11778
11779 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
11780 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
11781 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
11782
11783 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
11784 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
11785 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
11786 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
11787 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
11788 past.)
11789
11790 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
11791 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
11792 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
11793 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
11794 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
11795
11796 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
11797 and is an alias for it.
11798
11799 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
11800 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
11801
11802 ** Scrolling changes
11803
11804 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
11805 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
11806
11807 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
11808 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
11809 where it started.
11810
11811 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
11812 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
11813 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
11814 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
11815
11816 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
11817 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
11818 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
11819 recenters the window.
11820
11821 ** International character set support (MULE)
11822
11823 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
11824 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
11825 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
11826 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
11827 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
11828 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
11829
11830 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
11831 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
11832 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
11833 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
11834 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
11835
11836 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
11837 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
11838 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
11839 language, to make it possible to type them.
11840
11841 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
11842 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
11843
11844 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
11845 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
11846
11847 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
11848
11849 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
11850
11851 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
11852 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
11853 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
11854 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
11855 characters for their work until they want to change.
11856
11857 *** Input methods
11858
11859 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
11860 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
11861 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
11862 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
11863 support several input methods.
11864
11865 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
11866 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
11867 work.
11868
11869 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
11870 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
11871 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
11872 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
11873 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
11874 letter.
11875
11876 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
11877 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
11878 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
11879 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
11880 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
11881
11882 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
11883 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
11884 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
11885 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
11886
11887 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
11888 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
11889 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
11890 the first guess is wrong.
11891
11892 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
11893 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
11894
11895 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
11896 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
11897 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
11898 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
11899
11900 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
11901 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
11902 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
11903 translate automatically to and from either one.
11904
11905 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
11906
11907 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
11908 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
11909 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
11910 what you want.
11911
11912 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
11913 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
11914 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
11915 multibyte characters in that buffer.
11916
11917 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
11918 character conversion as well.
11919
11920 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
11921
11922 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
11923 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
11924 requires using many fonts.
11925
11926 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
11927 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
11928
11929 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
11930 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
11931 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
11932 you would use a font.
11933
11934 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
11935 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
11936 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
11937
11938 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
11939 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
11940 characters).
11941
11942 *** Defining fontsets.
11943
11944 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
11945 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
11946 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
11947
11948 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
11949 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
11950 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
11951 standard fontset are created automatically.
11952
11953 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
11954 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
11955 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
11956 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
11957 name is `fontset-startup'.
11958
11959 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
11960 The resource value should have this form:
11961 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
11962 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
11963 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
11964 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
11965 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
11966 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
11967 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
11968 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
11969 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
11970
11971 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
11972 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
11973 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
11974
11975 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
11976 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
11977 following resource,
11978 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
11979 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
11980 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
11981 Here is the substitution rule:
11982 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
11983 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
11984 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
11985 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
11986 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
11987
11988 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
11989 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
11990 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
11991
11992 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
11993 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
11994 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
11995 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
11996 fontsets.
11997
11998 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
11999 defaults for a particular choice of language.
12000
12001 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
12002 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
12003 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
12004 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
12005 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
12006 system for new files that you create.
12007
12008 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
12009 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
12010 whole Emacs session.
12011
12012 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
12013 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
12014 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
12015
12016 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
12017 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
12018 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
12019 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
12020 coding systems that Emacs supports.
12021
12022 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
12023 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
12024 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
12025 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
12026 is used for *the immediately following command*.
12027
12028 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
12029 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
12030
12031 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
12032 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
12033
12034 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
12035 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
12036
12037 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
12038 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
12039 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
12040 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
12041 of the file.
12042
12043 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
12044 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
12045 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
12046 translated into that character code.
12047
12048 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
12049 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
12050
12051 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
12052
12053 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
12054 the coding system for keyboard input.
12055
12056 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
12057 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
12058 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
12059
12060 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
12061
12062 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
12063 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
12064 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
12065 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
12066 designed to work with terminals.
12067
12068 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
12069 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
12070 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
12071 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
12072 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
12073 in the corresponding buffer.
12074
12075 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
12076
12077 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
12078 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
12079 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
12080
12081 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
12082 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
12083 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
12084 want to use.
12085
12086 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
12087 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
12088
12089 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
12090 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
12091 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
12092 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
12093
12094 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
12095 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
12096 related information.
12097
12098 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
12099 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
12100 scripts.
12101
12102 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
12103 information about the support for a particular language.
12104 You specify the language as an argument.
12105
12106 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
12107 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
12108 first dash.
12109
12110 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
12111 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
12112 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
12113 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
12114
12115 A alternativnyj (Russian)
12116 B big5 (Chinese)
12117 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
12118 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
12119 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
12120 E euc-japan (Japanese)
12121 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12122 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
12123 K euc-korea (Korean)
12124 R koi8 (Russian)
12125 Q tibetan
12126 S shift_jis (Japanese)
12127 T lao
12128 T tis620 (Thai)
12129 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
12130 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12131 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
12132 v viqr (Vietnamese)
12133 z hz (Chinese)
12134
12135 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
12136 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
12137 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
12138 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
12139
12140 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
12141 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
12142
12143 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
12144 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
12145 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
12146 Rmail files themselves.
12147
12148 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
12149 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
12150
12151 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
12152 for sending mail:
12153
12154 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
12155 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
12156 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
12157 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
12158 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
12159
12160 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
12161 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
12162 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
12163 translations.
12164
12165 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
12166 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
12167 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
12168 without any conversion.
12169
12170 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
12171 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
12172 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
12173 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
12174
12175 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
12176 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
12177
12178 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
12179 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
12180
12181 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
12182 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
12183
12184 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
12185 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
12186 in the buffer before point.
12187
12188 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
12189 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
12190 you are using.
12191
12192 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
12193 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
12194
12195 ** File locking works with NFS now.
12196
12197 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
12198 in the same directory as FILENAME.
12199
12200 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
12201 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
12202 can become a bottleneck.
12203
12204 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
12205 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
12206 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
12207 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
12208 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
12209 so useful that the change is worth while.
12210
12211 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
12212 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
12213 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
12214 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
12215
12216 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
12217 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
12218 show-paren-mode.
12219
12220 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
12221 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
12222 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
12223
12224 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
12225 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
12226 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
12227
12228 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
12229 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
12230 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
12231
12232 ** Changes in View mode.
12233
12234 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
12235 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
12236
12237 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
12238 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
12239
12240 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
12241 previous state.
12242
12243 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
12244 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
12245
12246 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
12247 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
12248 not just the selected window.
12249
12250 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
12251 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
12252 turns View mode on or off.
12253
12254 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12255 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12256 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12257
12258 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12259 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12260
12261 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12262 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12263 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12264 which version to compare with.
12265
12266 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12267 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12268
12269 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12270 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12271 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12272 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12273
12274 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12275 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12276 blocks, all of them or none.
12277
12278 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12279 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12280 confirmation first.
12281
12282 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12283 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12284 However, the mode will not be changed if
12285 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12286 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12287 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12288 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12289
12290 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12291
12292 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12293 these commands do not change the major mode.
12294
12295 ** M-x occur changes.
12296
12297 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12298 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12299
12300 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12301 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12302 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12303
12304 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12305 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12306 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12307 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12308 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12309
12310 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12311 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12312 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12313 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12314
12315 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12316 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12317 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12318
12319 ** Outline mode changes.
12320
12321 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12322
12323 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12324
12325 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12326 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12327 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12328 was already active.
12329
12330 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12331 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12332 get confused by it.
12333
12334 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12335 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12336
12337 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12338
12339 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12340 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12341 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12342 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12343
12344 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12345 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12346 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12347
12348 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12349 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12350 values.
12351
12352 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12353 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12354 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12355 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12356
12357 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12358 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12359 can be. The default value is 30.
12360
12361 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12362
12363 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12364 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12365 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12366 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12367 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12368 behavior.
12369
12370 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12371 compose-mail-other-frame.
12372
12373 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12374 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12375 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12376 buffer that shows the original message.
12377
12378 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12379 with separator lines around the contents.
12380
12381 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12382 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12383 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12384 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12385
12386 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12387
12388 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12389 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12390 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12391 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12392
12393 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12394 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12395 /etc/passwd.
12396
12397 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12398 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12399 /etc/passwd.
12400
12401 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12402 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12403 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12404 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12405
12406 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12407 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12408 be taken to be magic.
12409
12410 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12411 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12412 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12413
12414 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12415 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12416
12417 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12418 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12419
12420 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12421
12422 new key dired.el binding old key
12423 ------- ---------------- -------
12424 * c dired-change-marks c
12425 * m dired-mark m
12426 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12427 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12428 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12429 * u dired-unmark u
12430 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
12431 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
12432 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12433 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12434 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12435 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12436
12437 ** Rmail changes.
12438
12439 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12440 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12441 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12442 each time you run it.
12443
12444 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12445 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12446
12447 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12448 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12449 means to move in the opposite direction.
12450
12451 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12452 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12453
12454 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12455 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12456 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12457 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12458 for output.
12459
12460 ** Gnus changes.
12461
12462 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12463
12464 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12465 Gnus.
12466
12467 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12468 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12469
12470 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12471 article mode line.
12472
12473 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12474
12475 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
12476
12477 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
12478
12479 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
12480 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
12481 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
12482
12483 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
12484
12485 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
12486
12487 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
12488 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
12489
12490 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
12491 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
12492 used to pick articles.
12493
12494 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12495 another have been added.
12496
12497 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12498
12499 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12500 generating lines in buffers.
12501
12502 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12503 `C-M-_'.
12504
12505 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12506
12507 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12508
12509 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12510
12511 *** Scores can be decayed.
12512
12513 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12514
12515 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12516 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12517
12518 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12519 the native server.
12520
12521 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12522
12523 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
12524 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
12525
12526 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
12527
12528 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
12529 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
12530
12531 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
12532 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
12533
12534 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
12535 a group.
12536
12537 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
12538 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
12539
12540 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
12541
12542 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
12543
12544 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
12545
12546 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
12547
12548 Use the `Y c' command.
12549
12550 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
12551
12552 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
12553
12554 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
12555
12556 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
12557 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
12558
12559 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
12560
12561 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
12562
12563 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
12564 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
12565
12566 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
12567
12568 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
12569 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
12570 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
12571 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
12572 this issue.)
12573
12574 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
12575 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
12576 particular news group. This can be done by:
12577
12578 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
12579
12580 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
12581 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
12582 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
12583 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
12584 for reading and posting).
12585
12586 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
12587 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
12588 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
12589 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
12590 there.
12591
12592 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
12593 default. Here are some of these default settings:
12594
12595 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
12596 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
12597 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
12598 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
12599 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
12600
12601 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
12602 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
12603
12604 ** CC mode changes.
12605
12606 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
12607 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
12608 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
12609 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
12610 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
12611 loaded.
12612
12613 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
12614 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
12615 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
12616 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
12617 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
12618 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
12619
12620 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
12621 of the current buffer.
12622
12623 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
12624 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
12625 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
12626
12627 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
12628 style that the Python developers like.
12629
12630 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
12631 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
12632 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
12633
12634 ** VC Changes [new]
12635
12636 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
12637 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
12638 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
12639
12640 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
12641 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
12642 developers.
12643
12644 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
12645 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
12646
12647 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
12648 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
12649 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
12650 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
12651
12652 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
12653 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
12654
12655 ** Calendar changes.
12656
12657 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
12658 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
12659 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
12660 following/previous years.
12661
12662 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
12663 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
12664 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
12665 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
12666 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
12667 supposed attribute of God.
12668
12669 ** ps-print changes
12670
12671 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
12672 layout.
12673
12674 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
12675
12676 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
12677 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
12678 printer system has this behavior, set variable
12679 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
12680
12681 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
12682 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
12683 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
12684
12685 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
12686 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
12687
12688 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
12689 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
12690 printing for your printer.
12691
12692 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
12693 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12694
12695 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
12696 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12697
12698 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
12699 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
12700 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
12701 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
12702 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
12703 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
12704 The default value is nil.
12705
12706 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
12707 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
12708
12709 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
12710 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
12711 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
12712 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
12713 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
12714 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
12715 color). The default is 0 ("black").
12716
12717 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
12718 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
12719
12720 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
12721 The default is 0 ("black").
12722
12723 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
12724 The default is 0 ("black").
12725
12726 border-width Specify the border width.
12727 The default is 0.4.
12728
12729 Any other property is ignored.
12730
12731 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
12732 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
12733 documentation).
12734
12735 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
12736 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
12737 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
12738 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
12739 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
12740 controlling headers.
12741
12742 *** Color management (subgroup)
12743
12744 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
12745 color.
12746
12747 *** Face Management (subgroup)
12748
12749 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
12750 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
12751 background should be used. Valid values are:
12752
12753 t always use face background color.
12754 nil never use face background color.
12755 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
12756
12757 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
12758
12759 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
12760 sheet of paper.
12761
12762 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
12763 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
12764
12765 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
12766 each page.
12767
12768 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
12769 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
12770 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
12771
12772 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
12773 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
12774 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
12775
12776 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
12777 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
12778 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
12779
12780 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
12781 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
12782 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
12783
12784 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
12785 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
12786 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
12787
12788 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
12789
12790 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
12791
12792 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
12793 RGB color.
12794
12795 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
12796 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
12797 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
12798
12799 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
12800 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12801 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12802 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12803 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12804 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
12805 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
12806 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
12807 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12808 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12809 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12810 10 + 10 +
12811 11 + 11 +
12812 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12813 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12814 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
12815 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
12816 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
12817 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12818 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12819 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12820 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
12821 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
12822 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
12823 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
12824 22 + 22 +
12825 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12826
12827 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
12828
12829
12830 *** Printer management (subgroup)
12831
12832 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
12833 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
12834 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
12835 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
12836 to "-P".
12837
12838 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
12839 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
12840 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
12841
12842 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
12843 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
12844 do so.
12845
12846 *** Page settings (subgroup)
12847
12848 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
12849 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
12850 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
12851 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
12852 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
12853 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
12854 `setpagedevice'.
12855
12856 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
12857 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
12858 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
12859
12860 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
12861 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
12862 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
12863 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
12864 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
12865 its TO, are ignored.
12866
12867 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
12868 pages. Valid values are:
12869
12870 nil print all pages.
12871
12872 `even-page' print only even pages.
12873
12874 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
12875
12876 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
12877 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12878 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
12879 print only the even sheet of paper.
12880
12881 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
12882 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12883 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
12884 only the odd sheet of paper.
12885
12886 Any other value is treated as nil.
12887
12888 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
12889 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
12890 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
12891
12892 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
12893
12894 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
12895 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
12896
12897 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
12898 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12899 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
12900 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12901 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12902 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12903 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12904
12905 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
12906 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12907 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
12908 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
12909 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
12910 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
12911 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
12912
12913 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
12914
12915 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
12916 messages should be sent.
12917
12918 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
12919 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
12920 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
12921
12922 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
12923
12924 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
12925 points for line numbers.
12926
12927 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
12928 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
12929
12930 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
12931 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
12932 to 2, the printing will look like:
12933
12934 1 one line
12935 one line
12936 3 one line
12937 one line
12938 5 one line
12939 one line
12940 ...
12941
12942 Valid values are:
12943
12944 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
12945 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
12946 is used.
12947
12948 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
12949 zebra stripe is to be printed.
12950
12951 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
12952
12953 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
12954 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
12955 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
12956 3, the output will look like:
12957
12958 one line
12959 one line
12960 3 one line
12961 one line
12962 one line
12963 6 one line
12964 one line
12965 one line
12966 9 one line
12967 one line
12968 ...
12969
12970 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
12971 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
12972
12973 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
12974 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12975 `ps-font-size').
12976
12977 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
12978 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12979 `ps-font-size').
12980
12981 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
12982
12983 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
12984 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
12985
12986 ** hideshow changes.
12987
12988 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
12989 C++, ; for lisp).
12990
12991 *** Support for java-mode added.
12992
12993 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
12994 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
12995
12996 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
12997 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
12998 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
12999
13000 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
13001 robust and a lot faster.
13002
13003 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
13004
13005 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
13006 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
13007 documentation for more details.
13008
13009 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
13010
13011 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
13012 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
13013 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
13014 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
13015 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
13016
13017 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
13018 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
13019 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
13020 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
13021
13022 ** Font Lock mode
13023
13024 *** Custom support
13025
13026 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
13027 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
13028 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
13029 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
13030 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
13031 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
13032
13033 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
13034
13035 *** Maximum decoration
13036
13037 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
13038 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
13039 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
13040 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
13041 to get the old behavior.
13042
13043 *** New support
13044
13045 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
13046
13047 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
13048 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
13049
13050 *** Configurable support
13051
13052 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
13053 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
13054 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
13055 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
13056 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
13057 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
13058 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
13059
13060 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
13061 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
13062 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
13063
13064 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
13065
13066 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
13067 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
13068 for any mode.
13069
13070 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
13071
13072 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
13073
13074 in your ~/.emacs.
13075
13076 *** New faces
13077
13078 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
13079 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
13080 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
13081 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
13082
13083 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
13084
13085 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
13086 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
13087 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
13088
13089 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
13090
13091 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
13092 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
13093 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
13094 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
13095 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
13096 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
13097 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
13098
13099 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
13100 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
13101 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
13102 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
13103 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
13104 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
13105
13106 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
13107
13108 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
13109 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
13110 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
13111 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
13112
13113 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
13114 settings.
13115
13116 ** Ada mode changes.
13117
13118 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
13119 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
13120 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
13121 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
13122 stubs.
13123
13124 *** There are two new commands:
13125 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
13126 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
13127
13128 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
13129 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
13130 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
13131
13132 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
13133 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
13134 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
13135
13136 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
13137 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
13138 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
13139 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
13140
13141 ** Scheme mode changes.
13142
13143 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
13144 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
13145 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
13146 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
13147 have any effect.
13148
13149 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
13150 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
13151 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
13152 variables as buffer-local variables.
13153
13154 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
13155 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
13156
13157 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
13158
13159 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
13160 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
13161 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
13162 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
13163
13164 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
13165 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
13166 buffer in Emacs.
13167
13168 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
13169 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
13170 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
13171 option takes precedence.
13172
13173 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
13174 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
13175 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
13176
13177 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
13178 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
13179 the current defun.
13180
13181 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
13182 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
13183
13184 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
13185 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
13186 necessary).
13187
13188 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
13189 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
13190 these register values no longer become completely useless.
13191 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
13192 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
13193 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
13194
13195 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
13196 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
13197 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
13198 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
13199
13200 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
13201 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
13202 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
13203 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
13204 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
13205
13206 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
13207 since it applies only to the current frame.
13208
13209 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
13210 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
13211 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
13212
13213 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
13214 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
13215 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
13216 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
13217 instead of just the file you are editing.
13218
13219 ** RefTeX mode
13220
13221 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
13222 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
13223 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
13224 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
13225 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
13226
13227 C-c ( reftex-label
13228 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
13229 knows which kind of label is needed.
13230
13231 C-c ) reftex-reference
13232 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
13233 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
13234
13235 C-c [ reftex-citation
13236 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
13237 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
13238
13239 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
13240 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
13241
13242 C-c = reftex-toc
13243 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
13244 can quickly jump to every section.
13245
13246 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
13247 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
13248 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
13249 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
13250 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
13251
13252 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
13253
13254 *** Info documentation is now available.
13255
13256 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13257 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13258
13259 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13260 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13261
13262 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13263 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13264
13265 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13266 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13267 appropriate functions.
13268
13269 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13270 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13271
13272 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13273 been cleaned.
13274
13275 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13276 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13277
13278 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13279 shall be delimited.
13280
13281 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13282 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13283 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13284
13285 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13286 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13287 prefixed with `ALT'.
13288
13289 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13290 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13291 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13292 documentation).
13293
13294 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13295 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13296 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13297
13298 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13299 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13300
13301 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13302 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13303 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13304
13305 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13306
13307 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13308
13309 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13310 from alien sources.
13311
13312 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13313 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13314 crossref entries.
13315
13316 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13317 region.
13318
13319 *** Added support for imenu.
13320
13321 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13322 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13323 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13324 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13325
13326 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13327 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13328
13329 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13330
13331 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13332
13333 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13334 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13335 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13336 as an argument.
13337
13338 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13339 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13340
13341 ** browse-url changes
13342
13343 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13344 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13345 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13346 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13347 customization variables.
13348
13349 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13350
13351 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13352 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13353 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13354
13355 ** Changes in Ediff
13356
13357 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13358 pops up the Info file for this command.
13359
13360 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13361 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13362 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13363 directories).
13364
13365 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13366 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13367 files in the same directory.
13368
13369 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13370 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13371 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13372
13373 ** Changes in Viper
13374
13375 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13376 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13377 instead of vip-.
13378 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13379 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13380 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13381 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13382 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13383 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13384 color when Viper is in insert state.
13385 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13386 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13387 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13388
13389 ** Etags changes.
13390
13391 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13392 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13393 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13394 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13395 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13396
13397 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13398
13399 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13400 constructs are tagged. Files are recognized by the extension .java.
13401
13402 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13403 recognized by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13404 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13405
13406 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13407 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13408 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13409 methods and protocols.
13410
13411 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognized by the extension
13412 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13413 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13414 paragraph name.
13415
13416 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13417 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13418 at least M times and as many as N times.
13419
13420 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13421 in files has changed slightly.
13422
13423 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13424 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13425 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13426 with old time-stamp-format values.
13427
13428 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13429 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13430 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13431 reasons.
13432
13433 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13434 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13435 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13436 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13437 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13438 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13439
13440 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13441 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13442 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13443
13444 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13445 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13446 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13447 recommended now will continue to work then.
13448
13449 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13450 details.
13451
13452 ** There are some additional major modes:
13453
13454 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13455 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13456 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13457
13458 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13459 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13460 into Emacs.
13461
13462 ** New Lisp packages include:
13463
13464 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13465
13466 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13467 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13468
13469 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13470
13471 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13472 in shell buffers.
13473
13474 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
13475 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
13476 and `elint-defun'.
13477
13478 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
13479 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
13480 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
13481 strings or comments.
13482
13483 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
13484 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
13485 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
13486 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
13487 at these points.
13488
13489 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
13490 can visit them by short forms of their names.
13491
13492 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
13493 Emacs Lisp function at point.
13494
13495 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13496
13497 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13498 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13499
13500 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13501
13502 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13503
13504 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13505
13506 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13507 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13508
13509 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13510 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13511 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13512 original place after inserting the copy.
13513
13514 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13515 on the buffer.
13516
13517 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13518 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13519 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13520
13521 Enable mouse-drag with:
13522 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13523 -or-
13524 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13525
13526 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
13527 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
13528
13529 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
13530 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
13531
13532 *** ogonek
13533
13534 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
13535 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
13536 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
13537 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
13538 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
13539 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
13540 instance) and vice versa.
13541
13542 To use this package load it using
13543 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
13544 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
13545 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
13546 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
13547 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
13548 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
13549
13550 *** Interface to ph.
13551
13552 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
13553
13554 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
13555 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
13556 these servers.
13557
13558 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
13559
13560 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
13561 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
13562 while the real cursor does not move.
13563
13564 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
13565 for visiting your favorite web sites.
13566
13567 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
13568 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
13569
13570 ** movemail change
13571
13572 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
13573 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
13574 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
13575 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
13576
13577 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
13578 \f
13579 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
13580
13581 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
13582
13583 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
13584 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
13585 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
13586 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
13587 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
13588
13589 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
13590 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
13591 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
13592 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
13593 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
13594 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
13595 \f
13596 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
13597
13598 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
13599 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
13600 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
13601 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
13602
13603 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
13604 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
13605
13606 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
13607 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
13608 "win".
13609
13610 ** Basic Lisp changes
13611
13612 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
13613 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
13614
13615 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
13616 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
13617 or by the user.
13618
13619 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
13620
13621 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
13622
13623 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
13624 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
13625
13626 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
13627 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
13628 its argument.
13629
13630 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
13631
13632 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
13633
13634 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
13635
13636 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
13637 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
13638 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
13639 `format' function.
13640
13641 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
13642 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
13643 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
13644
13645 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
13646 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
13647 adding one of these suffixes.
13648
13649 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
13650 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
13651 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
13652
13653 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
13654 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
13655
13656 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
13657
13658 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
13659 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
13660
13661 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
13662 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
13663
13664 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
13665
13666 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
13667 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
13668
13669 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
13670 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
13671 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
13672 works using `save-current-buffer'.
13673
13674 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
13675 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
13676 of the last form.
13677
13678 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
13679 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
13680 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
13681 as the last form.
13682
13683 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
13684 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
13685 matches.
13686
13687 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
13688
13689 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
13690 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
13691 Then it returns that string.
13692
13693 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
13694
13695 (with-output-to-string
13696 (princ "The buffer is ")
13697 (princ (buffer-name)))
13698
13699 returns "The buffer is foo".
13700
13701 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
13702 is non-nil.
13703
13704 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
13705 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
13706 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
13707
13708 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
13709 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
13710
13711 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
13712 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
13713 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
13714 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
13715 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
13716 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
13717
13718 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
13719 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
13720 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
13721 characters".
13722
13723 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
13724 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
13725 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
13726 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
13727 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
13728
13729 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
13730 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
13731 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
13732 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
13733
13734 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
13735 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
13736
13737 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
13738
13739 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
13740 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
13741 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
13742 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
13743 guaranteed.
13744
13745 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
13746 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
13747 character).
13748
13749 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
13750
13751 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
13752 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
13753 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
13754 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
13755 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
13756
13757 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
13758
13759 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
13760 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
13761 more than the number of characters.
13762
13763 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
13764 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
13765 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
13766 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
13767 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
13768 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
13769
13770 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
13771 and returns a string containing those characters.
13772
13773 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
13774 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
13775 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
13776 character, sref signals an error.
13777
13778 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
13779 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
13780 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13781
13782 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
13783 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
13784 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13785
13786 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
13787 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
13788 to a vector of the characters in it.
13789
13790 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
13791 of a string. You call it as follows:
13792
13793 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
13794
13795 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
13796 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
13797 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
13798 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
13799 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
13800
13801 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
13802 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13803
13804 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
13805 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13806
13807 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
13808 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
13809 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
13810 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
13811
13812 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
13813
13814 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
13815
13816 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
13817 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
13818 are not included in the resulting value.
13819
13820 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
13821 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
13822 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
13823 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
13824
13825 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
13826 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
13827 character extends across that column), then the padding character
13828 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
13829 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
13830 column START-COLUMN.
13831
13832 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
13833 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
13834 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
13835 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
13836 changed text, before the change.
13837
13838 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
13839 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
13840 one character set for each script, not for each language.
13841
13842 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
13843
13844 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
13845
13846 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
13847 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
13848
13849 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
13850 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
13851 which identify the character within that character set.
13852
13853 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
13854 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
13855 opposite of split-char.
13856
13857 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
13858 of all the characters between BEG and END.
13859
13860 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
13861 of all the characters in a string.
13862
13863 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
13864 and specifying coding systems.
13865
13866 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
13867 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
13868 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
13869 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
13870 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
13871 as what to do about code conversion.)
13872
13873 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
13874 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
13875
13876 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13877 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13878 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
13879
13880 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13881 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
13882 to match against a file name.
13883
13884 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13885 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13886 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13887 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13888 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13889 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13890
13891 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13892 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13893
13894 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
13895 the coding system to use for network sockets.
13896
13897 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13898 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
13899 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
13900 service names.
13901
13902 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13903 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13904 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13905 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13906 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13907 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13908
13909 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13910 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13911
13912 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13913 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13914 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
13915 start the subprocess.
13916
13917 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
13918 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
13919 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
13920 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
13921 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
13922
13923 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
13924 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
13925 subprocess.
13926
13927 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
13928 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
13929 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
13930 connection permanently or until overridden.
13931
13932 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
13933 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
13934 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
13935 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
13936 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
13937 system for one operation at a time.
13938
13939 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
13940 files, subprocesses or network connections.
13941
13942 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
13943 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
13944 The value is a cons cell,
13945 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
13946 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
13947 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
13948 input to the subprocess.
13949
13950 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
13951 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
13952
13953 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
13954 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
13955 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
13956
13957 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
13958 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
13959 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
13960 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
13961 customization.
13962
13963 Thus, instead of writing
13964
13965 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
13966 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
13967
13968 you would now write this:
13969
13970 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
13971 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
13972 :type 'boolean
13973 :group foo)
13974
13975 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
13976 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
13977 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
13978 for a description of them.
13979
13980 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
13981 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
13982
13983 (defgroup ispell nil
13984 "Spell checking using Ispell."
13985 :group 'processes)
13986
13987 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
13988 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
13989 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
13990 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
13991 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
13992
13993 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
13994 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
13995 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
13996 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
13997 first-level subgroups.
13998
13999 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
14000
14001 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
14002 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
14003
14004 ** easy-mmode
14005
14006 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
14007 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
14008 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
14009 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
14010 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
14011 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
14012
14013 ** Text property changes
14014
14015 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
14016 text property.
14017
14018 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
14019 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
14020 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
14021 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
14022 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
14023
14024 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
14025 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
14026 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
14027 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
14028
14029 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
14030 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
14031 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
14032
14033 ** Changes in invisibility features
14034
14035 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
14036 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
14037 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
14038 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
14039 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
14040 make the overlay visible.
14041
14042 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
14043 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
14044 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
14045 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
14046 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
14047 t when it should hide it.
14048
14049 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
14050
14051 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
14052 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
14053 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
14054 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
14055 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
14056 Here is an example of how to do this:
14057
14058 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
14059 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14060 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
14061 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14062
14063 ...
14064 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
14065
14066 ...
14067 ;; When done with the overlays:
14068 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14069 ;; Or respectively:
14070 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14071
14072 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
14073
14074 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
14075 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
14076 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
14077 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
14078
14079 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
14080 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
14081 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
14082
14083 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
14084 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
14085
14086 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
14087 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
14088
14089 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
14090 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
14091 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
14092
14093 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
14094 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
14095 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
14096 determine the syntax type of the character.
14097
14098 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
14099 of the current buffer.
14100
14101 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
14102 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
14103 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
14104
14105 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
14106 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
14107 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
14108 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
14109 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
14110
14111 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
14112 text property.
14113
14114 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
14115 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
14116 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
14117
14118 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
14119 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
14120 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
14121 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
14122 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
14123
14124 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
14125 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
14126 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
14127
14128 ** Changes in face features
14129
14130 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
14131 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
14132
14133 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
14134 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
14135
14136 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
14137 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
14138
14139 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
14140 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
14141
14142 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
14143 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
14144 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
14145 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
14146 overlay property).
14147
14148 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
14149 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
14150
14151 ** Changes in file-handling functions
14152
14153 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
14154 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
14155 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
14156 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
14157
14158 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
14159 begins with ~.
14160
14161 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
14162 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
14163
14164 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
14165 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
14166
14167 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
14168 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
14169
14170 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
14171 character code conversion as well as other things.
14172
14173 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
14174 (formerly it did not).
14175
14176 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
14177 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
14178
14179 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
14180 instead of constant strings.
14181
14182 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
14183 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
14184 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
14185
14186 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
14187 in the same way as before.
14188
14189 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
14190 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
14191 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
14192
14193 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
14194 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
14195 else, and returns nil.
14196
14197 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
14198 directory cannot be listed.
14199
14200 ** Changes in minibuffer input
14201
14202 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
14203 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
14204 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
14205 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
14206 ways:
14207
14208 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
14209 It is available through the history command M-n.
14210
14211 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
14212 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
14213 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
14214 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
14215 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
14216
14217 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
14218 argument in this way.
14219
14220 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
14221 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
14222 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
14223
14224 ** Echo area features
14225
14226 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
14227 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
14228 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
14229 after the echo area is cleared.
14230
14231 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
14232 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
14233
14234 ** Keyboard input features
14235
14236 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
14237 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
14238
14239 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
14240 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
14241 by keyboard macros.
14242
14243 ** Frame-related changes
14244
14245 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
14246 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
14247 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
14248
14249 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
14250 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
14251 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
14252
14253 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14254 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14255 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14256 in the selected frame.
14257
14258 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14259 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14260 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14261
14262 ** X Windows features
14263
14264 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14265 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14266 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14267
14268 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14269 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14270
14271 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14272 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14273 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14274
14275 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14276 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14277
14278 ** Subprocess features
14279
14280 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14281 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14282 automatically.
14283
14284 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14285 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14286
14287 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14288 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14289
14290 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14291 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14292
14293 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14294 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14295 goes after the other menu items.
14296
14297 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14298 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14299 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14300 are in use.
14301
14302 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14303 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14304
14305 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14306 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14307 form.
14308
14309 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14310 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14311 but its hook is still run.
14312
14313 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14314 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14315
14316 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14317 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14318 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14319
14320 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14321 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14322 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14323 warned.
14324
14325 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14326 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14327
14328 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14329 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14330 functions like display-time.
14331
14332 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14333 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14334
14335 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14336 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14337 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14338
14339 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14340 if there is an error in compilation.
14341
14342 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14343 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14344 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14345 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14346
14347 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14348 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14349 the *scratch* buffer.
14350
14351 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14352 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14353 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14354 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14355
14356 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14357 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14358 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14359
14360 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14361 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14362 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14363 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14364
14365 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14366 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14367 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14368
14369 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14370 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14371 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14372 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14373 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14374 files at all.
14375
14376 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14377 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14378 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14379 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14380
14381 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14382 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14383 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14384 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14385
14386 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14387
14388 ** imenu.el changes.
14389
14390 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14391 item from menu created by imenu.
14392
14393 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14394 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14395 select one of those items.
14396 \f
14397 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14398
14399 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
14400 Copyright information:
14401
14402 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14403
14404 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14405 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14406 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14407 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14408
14409 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14410 of this document, or of portions of it,
14411 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14412 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
14413 \f
14414 Local variables:
14415 mode: outline
14416 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14417 end:
14418
14419 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793